nulink: add minimal support for Nu-Link2
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
509 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
510 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
511 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
512 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
513
514 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
515 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
516 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
517
518 @section USB Other
519 @itemize @bullet
520 @item @b{USBprog}
521 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
522
523 @item @b{USB - Presto}
524 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
525
526 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
527 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
528
529 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
530 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
531
532 @item @b{Buspirate}
533 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
534
535 @item @b{opendous}
536 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
537
538 @item @b{estick}
539 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
540
541 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
543
544 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
546 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
547 @end itemize
548
549 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
550
551 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
552 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
553 these on the market.
554
555 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
556 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
557 of USB-based ones.
558
559 @itemize @bullet
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
562 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
563
564 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
565 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
566 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
567
568 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
569 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
570
571 @item @b{Wiggler2}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
573
574 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
575 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
576
577 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
578 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
579
580 @item @b{arm-jtag}
581 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
582
583 @item @b{chameleon}
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
585
586 @item @b{Triton}
587 @* Unknown.
588
589 @item @b{Lattice}
590 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
591 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
592
593 @item @b{flashlink}
594 @* From STMicroelectronics;
595 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
596
597 @end itemize
598
599 @section Other...
600 @itemize @bullet
601
602 @item @b{ep93xx}
603 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
604
605 @item @b{at91rm9200}
606 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
607
608 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
609 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
610
611 @item @b{imx_gpio}
612 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
613
614 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
615 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
616 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
617
618 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
619 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
620
621 @end itemize
622
623 @node About Jim-Tcl
624 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex Jim-Tcl
626 @cindex tcl
627
628 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
629 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
630 command interpreter.
631
632 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
633 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
634 much of anything about Tcl.
635 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
636
637 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
638 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
639 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
640 OpenOCD mailing list.
641
642 @itemize @bullet
643 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
644 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
645 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
646 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
647 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
648 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
649
650 @item @b{Missing Features}
651 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
652 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
653 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
654 enabled in OpenOCD.
655
656 @item @b{Scripts}
657 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
658 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
659 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
660
661 @item @b{Commands}
662 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
663 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
664 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
665 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
666
667 @item @b{Historical Note}
668 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
669 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
670 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
671 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
672
673 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
674 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
675 @end itemize
676
677 @node Running
678 @chapter Running
679 @cindex command line options
680 @cindex logfile
681 @cindex directory search
682
683 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
684 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
685 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
686 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
687 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
688 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
689 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
690
691 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
692 tell it how each debug session should work.
693 The @option{--help} option shows:
694 @verbatim
695 bash$ openocd --help
696
697 --help | -h display this help
698 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
699 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
700 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
701 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
702 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
703 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
704 --command | -c run <command>
705 @end verbatim
706
707 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
708 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
709 To specify one or more different
710 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
711
712 @example
713 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
714 @end example
715
716 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
717 @enumerate
718 @item the current directory,
719 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
720 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
721 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
722 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
723 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
724 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
725 @end enumerate
726 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
727
728 @quotation Note
729 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
730 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
731 @end quotation
732
733 @section Simple setup, no customization
734
735 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
736 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
737 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
738 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
739 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
740
741 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
742 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
743 the server with some variation of one of the following:
744
745 @example
746 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
748 @end example
749
750 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
751 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
752 If all goes well you'll see output something like
753
754 @example
755 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
756 For bug reports, read
757 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
758 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
759 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
760 @end example
761
762 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
763 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
764 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
765
766 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
767
768 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
769 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
770 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
771 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
772 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
773 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
774 ensure that this always succeeds.
775 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
776 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
777 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
778 and then shut down without acting as a server.
779
780 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
781 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
782 those channels.
783
784 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
785 the @option{-d} option.
786
787 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
788 @option{-c} command line switch.
789
790 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
791 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
792 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
793 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
794 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
795 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
796 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
797
798 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
799 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
800
801 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
802 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
803 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
804 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
805
806 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
807 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
808
809 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
810 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
811 and start the OpenOCD server.
812 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
813 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
814 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
815 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
816
817 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
818
819 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
820 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
821 and a USB cable on the other.
822 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
823 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
824
825 @enumerate
826 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
827 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
828 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
829 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
830 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
831 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
832 debugging host.
833
834 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
835 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
836 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
837 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
838 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
839
840 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
841 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
842 with 1.2 Volt boards.
843
844 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
845 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
846 ways to connect the cable.
847 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
848 Be sure it's firmly connected.
849
850 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
851 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
852 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
853 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
854 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
855 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
856 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
857 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
858
859 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
860 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
861 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
862 but are tedious to set up.
863 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
864 adapter signals to the right board pins.
865
866 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
867 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
868 you are using to run OpenOCD.
869 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
870
871 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
872 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
873 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
874 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
875
876 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
877 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
878 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
879
880 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
881 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
882 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
883 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
884
885 @end enumerate
886
887 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
888 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
889 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
890
891 @section Project Directory
892
893 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
894
895 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
896 single directory for your work with a given board.
897 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
898 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
899 files accessed through semihosting,
900 and for code you upload to the target board.
901 It is also the natural place to write files,
902 such as log files and data you download from the board.
903
904 @section Configuration Basics
905
906 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
907 a variety of ways you can mix them.
908 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
909
910 @itemize
911 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
912 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
913 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
914 @end itemize
915
916 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
917 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
918 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
919
920 @example
921 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
922
923 # GDB can also flash my flash!
924 gdb_memory_map enable
925 gdb_flash_program enable
926
927 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
928 @end example
929
930 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
931
932 @example
933 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
934 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
935 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
936 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
937 @end example
938
939 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
940 each supporting a different development task.
941 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
942 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
943
944 @quotation Important
945 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
946 problems with how it treats variables.
947 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
948 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
949 that can be tested in a later script.
950 @end quotation
951
952 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
953 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
954 to simplify your work.
955
956 @section User Config Files
957 @cindex config file, user
958 @cindex user config file
959 @cindex config file, overview
960
961 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
962 in one place.
963 One of the following will match your situation best:
964
965 @itemize
966 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
967 provided by someone else.
968 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
969 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
970 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
971 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
972 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
973 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
974
975 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
976 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
977
978 @enumerate
979 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
980 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
981 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
982 @end enumerate
983
984 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
985 The first is an interface config file.
986 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
987 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
988 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
989 meet your deadline:
990
991 @example
992 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
993 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
994 @end example
995
996 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
997 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
998 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
999 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1000
1001 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1002 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1003 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1004 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1005 target and board
1006 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1007 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1008
1009 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1010 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1011 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1012 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1013
1014 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1015 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1016 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1017 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1018 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1019
1020 @quotation Note
1021 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1022 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1023 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1024 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1025 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1026 @end quotation
1027
1028 @item
1029 You may need to write some C code.
1030 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1031 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1032 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1033 a new chip architecture.
1034 @end itemize
1035
1036 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1037 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1038 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1039
1040 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1041 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1042 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1043 @itemize
1044
1045 @item
1046 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1047 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1048 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1049 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1050
1051 @item
1052 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1053 @cindex vector_catch
1054 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1055 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1056 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1057 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1058 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1059 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1060
1061 @item
1062 You might need to override some defaults.
1063 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1064 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1065
1066 @item
1067 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1068 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1069 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1070 @end itemize
1071
1072 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1073
1074 A few project-specific utility
1075 routines may well speed up your work.
1076 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1077
1078 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1079 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1080 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1081 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1082 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1083 may help:
1084
1085 @example
1086 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1087 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1088 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1089 # Leave the CPU halted.
1090 reset init
1091
1092 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1093 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1094
1095 # Start running.
1096 resume 0x20000000
1097 @}
1098 @end example
1099
1100 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1101 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1102 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1103 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1104 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1105
1106 @example
1107 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1108 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1109 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1110 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1111 reset init
1112
1113 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1114 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1115 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1116 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1117 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1118 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1119 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1120
1121 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1122 reset run
1123 @}
1124 @end example
1125
1126 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1127 from NAND.
1128 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1129 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1130 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1131
1132 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1133 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1134
1135 @section Target Software Changes
1136
1137 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1138 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1139 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1140 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1141 handling issues like:
1142
1143 @itemize @bullet
1144
1145 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1146 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1147 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1148 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1149 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1150 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1151 your debug sessions.
1152
1153 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1154 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1155 That might however be your only option.
1156
1157 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1158 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1159 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1160 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1161 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1162 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1163 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1164 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1165 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1166 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1167 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1168 instead of the whole thing.
1169 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1170 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1171
1172 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1173 @cindex ARM semihosting
1174 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1175 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1176 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1177 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1178 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1179 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1180 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1181 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1182 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1183 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1184 NAND or SPI flash.
1185
1186 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1187 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1188 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1189 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1190 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1191
1192 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1193 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1194 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1195 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1196 registers which can be used to change various features including
1197 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1198 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1199 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1200 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1201 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1202
1203 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1204 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1205 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1206 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1207 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1208
1209 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1210 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1211 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1212 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1213 early code execution can be debugged
1214 or firmware can be replaced.
1215
1216 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1217 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1218 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1219 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1220 operations like writing to memory.)
1221
1222 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1223 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1224 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1225 various kinds of message.
1226 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1227
1228 @end itemize
1229
1230 @section Target Hardware Setup
1231
1232 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1233 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1234 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1235 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1236 working with.}
1237
1238 Common issues include:
1239
1240 @itemize @bullet
1241
1242 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1243 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1244 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1245 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1246 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1247 or one from a daughtercard).
1248 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1249 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1250
1251 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1252 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1253 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1254 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1255 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1256 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1257
1258 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1259 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1260 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1261 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1262 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1263
1264
1265 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1266 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1267 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1268 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1269 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1270 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1271 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1272
1273 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1274 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1275 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1276 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1277 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1278
1279 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1280 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1281 used to start booting.
1282
1283 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1284 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1285 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1286 multiple audio codec chips).
1287 This interacts with software
1288 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1289 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1290 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1291 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1292 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1293 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1294 audio or video codecs are used.
1295
1296 @end itemize
1297
1298 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1299 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1300 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1301 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1302 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1303 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1304 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1305 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1306 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1307 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1308
1309
1310 @node Config File Guidelines
1311 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1312
1313 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1314 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1315 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1316 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1317
1318 You should find the following directories under
1319 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1320 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1321 @itemize @bullet
1322 @item @file{interface} ...
1323 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1324 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1325 @item @file{board} ...
1326 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1327 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1328
1329 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1330 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1331 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1332 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1333 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1334 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1335 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1336 a CPU and an FPGA.
1337 @item @file{target} ...
1338 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1339 on a chip
1340 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1341 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1342 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1343 the target config file defines all of them.
1344 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1345 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1346 @end itemize
1347
1348 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1349 file may override features in any of the above files by
1350 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1351 commands specific to their situation.
1352
1353 @section Interface Config Files
1354
1355 The user config file
1356 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1357
1358 @example
1359 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1360 @end example
1361
1362 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1363 in use today with OpenOCD.
1364 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1365 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1366
1367 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1368 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1369 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1370 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1371 and need to provide a driver for it.
1372
1373 @section Board Config Files
1374 @cindex config file, board
1375 @cindex board config file
1376
1377 The user config file
1378 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1379
1380 @example
1381 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1382 @end example
1383
1384 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1385 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1386 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1387
1388 @enumerate
1389 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1390 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1391 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1392 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1393 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1394 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1395 @end enumerate
1396
1397 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1398 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1399 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1400 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1401
1402 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1403 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1404 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1405 configuration works.
1406
1407 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1408
1409 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1410 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1411 convention on how to use certain variables.
1412
1413 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1414 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1415 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1416 used at will within a target configuration file.
1417
1418 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1419 for a board with three chips:
1420
1421 @example
1422 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1423 set CHIPNAME network
1424 set ENDIAN big
1425 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1426 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1427 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1428 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1429
1430 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1431 set CHIPNAME video
1432 set ENDIAN little
1433 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1434 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1435 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1436 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1437
1438 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1439 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1440 unset ENDIAN
1441 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1442 @end example
1443
1444 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1445 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1446 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1447 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1448 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1449 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1450 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1451 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1452
1453 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1454 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1455 naming collisions.
1456
1457 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1458 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1459 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1460 up other clocks and peripherals.
1461
1462 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1463 @cindex variable names
1464
1465 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1466 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1467 one such chip (as shown above).
1468 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1469 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1470 to promote consistency and
1471 so that board files can override target defaults.
1472
1473 Inputs to target config files include:
1474
1475 @itemize @bullet
1476 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1477 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1478 tap identifier dotted names.
1479 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1480 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1481 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1482 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1483 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1484 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1485 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1486 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1487 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1488 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1489 @end itemize
1490
1491 Outputs from target config files include:
1492
1493 @itemize @bullet
1494 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1495 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1496 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1497 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1498 specific to that board and that target.
1499 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1500 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1501 @end itemize
1502
1503 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1504 @cindex event, reset-init
1505 @cindex reset-init handler
1506
1507 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1508 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1509 fully set up yet.
1510 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1511 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1512 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1513 handler is one of the most important.
1514
1515 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1516 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1517 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1518 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1519 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1520
1521 @quotation Note
1522 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1523 are included here.
1524 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1525 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1526 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1527 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1528 @end quotation
1529
1530 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1531 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1532 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1533 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1534 those as parameters.
1535 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1536 and disabling the watchdog.
1537 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1538 the next developer doing such work.
1539 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1540
1541 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1542 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1543 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1544 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1545
1546 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1547
1548 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1549 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1550 a low JTAG clock rate.
1551 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1552 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1553 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1554 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1555 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1556 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1557 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1558
1559 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1560 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1561 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1562 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1563 which might be less than that.
1564
1565 @quotation Warning
1566 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1567 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1568 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1569 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1570 @end quotation
1571
1572 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1573 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1574 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1575 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1576 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1577 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1578
1579 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1580 @subsection The init_board procedure
1581 @cindex init_board procedure
1582
1583 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1584 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1585 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1586 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1587 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1588 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1589 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1590 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1591 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1592 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1593 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1594 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1595
1596 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1597 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1598
1599 @example
1600 ### board_file.cfg ###
1601
1602 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1603 source [find target/target.cfg]
1604
1605 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1606 # enables fast on-board clock source
1607 # configures the chip to use it
1608 @}
1609
1610 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1611 proc init_board @{@} @{
1612 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1613
1614 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1615 adapter speed 100
1616 @}
1617
1618 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1619 enable_fast_clock
1620 adapter speed 10000
1621 @}
1622 @}
1623 @end example
1624
1625 @section Target Config Files
1626 @cindex config file, target
1627 @cindex target config file
1628
1629 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1630 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1631 more target config files like this:
1632
1633 @example
1634 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1635 @end example
1636
1637 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1638 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1639 In summary the target files should contain
1640
1641 @enumerate
1642 @item Set defaults
1643 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1644 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1645 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1646 @item On-Chip flash
1647 @end enumerate
1648
1649 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1650 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1651 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1652
1653 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1654 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1655 can talk to the chip.
1656 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1657 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1658 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1659 and other processing engines.
1660
1661 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1662
1663 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1664 letting board config files express environment-specific
1665 differences in how things should be set up.
1666
1667 @example
1668 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1669 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1670 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1671 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1672 @} else @{
1673 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1674 @}
1675
1676 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1677 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1678 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1679 @} else @{
1680 set _ENDIAN little
1681 @}
1682
1683 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1684 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1685 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1686 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1687 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1688 @} else @{
1689 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1690 @}
1691 @end example
1692 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1693
1694 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1695 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1696 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1697
1698 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1699 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1700 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1701
1702 @example
1703 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1704 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1705 @end example
1706
1707 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1708 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1709 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1710 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1711 for taps.
1712
1713 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1714 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1715 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1716 looks (in part) like this:
1717
1718 @example
1719 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1720 @end example
1721
1722 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1723 to source such a config file twice, with different
1724 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1725 it adds a different TAP each time.
1726
1727 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1728 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1729 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1730 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1731
1732 @example
1733 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1734 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1735 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1736 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1737 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1738 @end example
1739
1740 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1741 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1742
1743 @itemize
1744 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1745 plus a JRC to enable them
1746 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1747 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1748 is not currently used)
1749 @end itemize
1750
1751 @subsection Add CPU targets
1752
1753 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1754 GDB and other commands can use it.
1755 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1756 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1757 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1758 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1759
1760 @example
1761 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1763 @end example
1764
1765 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1766 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1767 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1768 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1769 a work area if you can.
1770 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1771
1772 @example
1773 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1774 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1775 @end example
1776
1777 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1778 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1779 @cindex SMP
1780 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1781
1782 @example
1783 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1784 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1785 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1786 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1787 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1788 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1789 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1790 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1791 @end example
1792 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1793 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1796 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1797 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1798 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1799 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1800 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1801 @end itemize
1802
1803 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1804 command have been implemented.
1805 @itemize @bullet
1806 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1807 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1808 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1809 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1810 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1811 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1812 following example.
1813 @end itemize
1814
1815 @example
1816 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1817 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1818 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1819 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1820 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1821 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1822 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1823 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1824 > resume
1825 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1826 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1827 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1828 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1829 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1830 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1831 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1832 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1833 @end example
1834
1835
1836 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1837
1838 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1839 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1840 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1841
1842 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1843 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1844 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1845 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1846 both signals.
1847
1848 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1849 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1850 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1851 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1852 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1853 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1854 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1855 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1856 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1857 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1858 not available.)
1859
1860 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1861 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1862 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1863 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1864 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1865 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1866 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1867 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1868
1869 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1870 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1871 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1872 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1873 slower clock than they will use later.
1874 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1875 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1876 than they will use later.
1877 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1878
1879 @quotation Important
1880 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1881 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1882 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1883 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1884 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1885 @end quotation
1886
1887 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1888 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1889 @cindex init_targets procedure
1890
1891 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1892 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1893 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1894 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1895 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1896 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1897 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1898 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1899 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1900
1901 @example
1902 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1905 # basic initialization procedure ...
1906 @}
1907
1908 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1909 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1910 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1911 @}
1912
1913 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1914
1915 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1916
1917 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1918 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1919 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1920 @}
1921 @end example
1922
1923 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1924 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1925
1926 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1927
1928 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1929 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1930
1931 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1932 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1933 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1934
1935 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1936 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1937 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1938 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1939 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1940 events already assigned.
1941
1942 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1943
1944 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1945 special high speed download features - enable it.
1946
1947 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1948
1949 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1950 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1951 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1952 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1953 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1954 If you are using an external trace port,
1955 configure it in your board config file.
1956 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1957 configure it in your target config file.
1958
1959 @example
1960 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1961 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1962 @end example
1963
1964 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1965
1966 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1967
1968 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1969 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1970 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1971 the TARGET (chip) file.
1972
1973 Examples:
1974 @itemize @bullet
1975 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1976 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1977 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1978 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1979 @end itemize
1980
1981 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1982 @section Translating Configuration Files
1983 @cindex translation
1984 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1985 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1986 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1987 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1988 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1989 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1990
1991 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1992 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1993 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1994 convert other scripts later on.
1995
1996 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1997 replace job:
1998
1999 @example
2000 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2001 #
2002 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2003 #
2004 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2005 #
2006 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2007
2008 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2009 global TARGETNAME
2010
2011 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2012
2013 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2014 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2015 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2016 @}
2017 @end example
2018
2019
2020
2021 @node Server Configuration
2022 @chapter Server Configuration
2023 @cindex initialization
2024 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2025 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2026 supported.
2027
2028 @anchor{configurationstage}
2029 @section Configuration Stage
2030 @cindex configuration stage
2031 @cindex config command
2032
2033 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2034 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2035 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2036 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2037 inside startup scripts.
2038
2039 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2040 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2041 which may be issued interactively.
2042 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2043 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2044
2045 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2046 flash banks,
2047 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2048 and other basic setup.
2049 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2050 may access or activate TAPs.
2051 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2052 longer be issued.
2053
2054 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2055 @section Entering the Run Stage
2056
2057 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2058 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2059 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2060 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2061 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2062 You should see no errors at this point.
2063 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2064 commands you used to configure the server.
2065 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2066 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2067 on the scan chain.
2068
2069 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2070 become available.
2071 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2072 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2073 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2074 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2075 entry to the run stage.
2076
2077 @deffn {Config Command} init
2078 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2079 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2080 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2081 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2082 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2083 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2084
2085 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2086 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2087 configuration files and/or command line options.
2088
2089 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2090 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2091 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2092 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2093 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2094 @end deffn
2095
2096 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2097 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2098 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2099
2100 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2101 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2102 scan chain.
2103 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2104 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2105
2106 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2107 they return.
2108 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2109 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2110 @end deffn
2111
2112 @anchor{tcpipports}
2113 @section TCP/IP Ports
2114 @cindex TCP port
2115 @cindex server
2116 @cindex port
2117 @cindex security
2118 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2119 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2120 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2121
2122 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2123 access using one or more of these ports.
2124 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2125 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2126 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2127
2128 @anchor{gdb_port}
2129 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2130 @cindex GDB server
2131 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2132 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2133 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2134 the normal use cases.
2135
2136 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2137 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2138 disables the gdb server.
2139
2140 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2141 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2142
2143 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2144 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2145
2146 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2147 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2148 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2149
2150 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2151 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2152 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2153 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2154 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2155 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2156 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2157 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2158 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2159
2160 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2161 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2162 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2163 @end deffn
2164
2165 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2166 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2167 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2168 output from the Tcl engine.
2169 Intended as a machine interface.
2170 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2171 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2172 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2173 @end deffn
2174
2175 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2176 Specify or query the
2177 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2178 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2179 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2180 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2181 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2182 @end deffn
2183
2184 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2185 @section GDB Configuration
2186 @cindex GDB
2187 @cindex GDB configuration
2188 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2189 The ones listed here are static and global.
2190 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2191 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2192
2193 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2194 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2195 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2196 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2197 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2198 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2199 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2203 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2204 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2205 vFlash packet is received.
2206 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2207 @end deffn
2208
2209 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2210 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2211 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2212 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2213 for flash programming to work.
2214 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2215 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2220 by GDB memory read packets.
2221 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2222 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2223 @end deffn
2224
2225 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2226 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2227 packets report errors or not.
2228 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2229 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2230 @end deffn
2231
2232 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2233 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2234 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2235 @end deffn
2236
2237 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2238 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2239
2240 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2241 @end deffn
2242
2243 @anchor{eventpolling}
2244 @section Event Polling
2245
2246 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2247 where significant events can happen at any time.
2248 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2249 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2250 or to GDB.
2251
2252 Examples of such events include:
2253
2254 @itemize
2255 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2256 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2257 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2258 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2259 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2260 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2261 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2262 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2263 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2264 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2265 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2266 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2267 @end itemize
2268
2269 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2270 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2271 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2272 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2273 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2274
2275 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2276 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2277 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2278 to the various active targets.
2279 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2280 which is normally done in the background.
2281
2282 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2283 Poll the current target for its current state.
2284 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2285 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2286 specific information about the current state is printed.
2287 An optional parameter
2288 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2289
2290 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2291 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2292 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2293 @example
2294 > poll
2295 background polling: on
2296 target state: halted
2297 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2298 current mode: Supervisor
2299 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2300 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2301 >
2302 @end example
2303 @end deffn
2304
2305 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2306 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2307 @cindex config file, interface
2308 @cindex interface config file
2309
2310 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2311 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2312 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2313
2314 @quotation Note
2315 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2316 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2317 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2318 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2319 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2320 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2321 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2322 @end quotation
2323
2324 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2325 through commands in an interface configuration
2326 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2327 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2328
2329 @example
2330 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2331 @end example
2332
2333 These commands tell
2334 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2335 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2336
2337 @example
2338 # jlink interface
2339 adapter driver jlink
2340 @end example
2341
2342 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2343
2344
2345 @section Adapter Configuration
2346
2347 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2348 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2349 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2350
2351 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2352 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2353 target.
2354 @end deffn
2355
2356 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2357 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2358 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2359 @end deffn
2360 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2361 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2362 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2363 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2364 the hardware can support.
2365 @end deffn
2366
2367
2368
2369 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2370 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2371 @end deffn
2372
2373 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2374 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2375 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2376 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2377 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2378 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2379 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2380
2381 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2382 @end deffn
2383
2384 @section Interface Drivers
2385
2386 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2387 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2388 available at run time.
2389
2390 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2391 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2392 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2393 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2396 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2397 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2401 Displays status of RTCK option.
2402 Optionally sets that option first.
2403 @end deffn
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2407 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2408 This has one driver-specific command:
2409
2410 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2411 Logs some status
2412 @end deffn
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2416 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2417 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2418 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2419 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2420 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2421 @end deffn
2422
2423 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2424 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2425
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2427 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2428 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2429 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2430 @example
2431 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2432 @end example
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2436 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2437 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2438 @end deffn
2439
2440 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2441 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2442 @end deffn
2443 @end deffn
2444
2445 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2446 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2450 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2454 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2455 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2456
2457 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2458 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2459
2460 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2461 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2462
2463 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2464 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2465 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2466 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2467 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2468 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2469
2470 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2471 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2472 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2473 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2474 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2475
2476 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2477 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2478 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2479 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2480
2481 @itemize @minus
2482 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2483 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2484 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2485 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2486 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2487 switching data and direction as necessary
2488 @end itemize
2489
2490 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2491 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2492
2493 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2494 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2495 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2496 @example
2497 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2498 @end example
2499 @end deffn
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2502 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2503 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2504 during device selection.
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2508 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2509 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2510 is connected to the host.
2511 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2512 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2513 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2514 @end deffn
2515
2516 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2517 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2518 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2519
2520 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2521 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2522 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2523 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2524 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2525
2526 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2530 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2531 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2535 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2536 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2537 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2538 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2539 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2540 and initially asserted reset signals.
2541 @end deffn
2542
2543 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2544 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2545 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2546 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2547 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2548 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2549 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2550 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2551 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2552 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2553 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2554
2555 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2556 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2557 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2558 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2559 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2560 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2561
2562 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2563 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2564 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2565 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2566 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2567 are always driven by the FTDI.
2568
2569 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2570 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2571 @var{name}.
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2575 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2576 @itemize @minus
2577 @item @option{0}, drive low
2578 @item @option{1}, drive high
2579 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2580 @end itemize
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2584 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2588 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2589
2590 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2591 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2592 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2593 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2594 @itemize @minus
2595 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2596 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2597 @end itemize
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2601 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2602
2603 @end deffn
2604
2605 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2606 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2607 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2608 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2609
2610 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2611 @itemize @minus
2612 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2613 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2614 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2615 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2616 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2617 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2618 @end itemize
2619
2620 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2621 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2622 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2623 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2624 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2625 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2626 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2627 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2628
2629 FT232R
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item bit 7 - RI
2632 @item bit 6 - DCD
2633 @item bit 5 - DSR
2634 @item bit 4 - DTR
2635 @item bit 3 - CTS
2636 @item bit 2 - RTS
2637 @item bit 1 - RXD
2638 @item bit 0 - TXD
2639 @end itemize
2640
2641 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2642 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2645 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2646 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2650 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2651 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2652 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2656 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2657 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2661 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2665 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2669 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2673 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2677 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2681 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2685 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2686 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2687 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2688 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2689 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2690 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2691 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2692 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2693 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 @end deffn
2697
2698 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2699 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2700 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2701 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2702
2703 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2704 processors which are being simulated.
2705
2706 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2707 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2708 sockets instead of TCP.
2709 @end deffn
2710
2711 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2712 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2713 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2714 @end deffn
2715
2716 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2717 something like:
2718
2719 @example
2720 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2721 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2722 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2723 @end example
2724
2725 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2726 named mysocket:
2727
2728 @example
2729 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2730 remote_bitbang_port 0
2731 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2732 @end example
2733 @end deffn
2734
2735 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2736 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2737 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2738 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2739
2740 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2741 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2742 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2743 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2744 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2748 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2749 default values are used.
2750 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2751 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2752 @example
2753 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2754 @end example
2755 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2756 @example
2757 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2758 @end example
2759 @end deffn
2760
2761 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2762 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2763 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2764 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2765 target board.
2766
2767 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2768 @example
2769 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2770 reset_config srst_only
2771 @end example
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2775 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2776 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2777 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2778 @end deffn
2779
2780 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2781 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2782 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2783 @end deffn
2784
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2788 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2789 This has one driver-specific command:
2790
2791 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2792 Display either the address of the I/O port
2793 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2794 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2795 This is a write-once setting.
2796 @end deffn
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2800 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2801 transports.
2802
2803 @quotation Compatibility Note
2804 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2805 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2806 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2807 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2808 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2809 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2810 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2811 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2812 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2813 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2814 @end quotation
2815
2816 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2817 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2818 states.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2821 Display free device internal memory.
2822 @end deffn
2823 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2824 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2825 command version.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2828 Display the device configuration.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2831 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2832 power state.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2835 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2836 @end deffn
2837 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2838 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2839 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2840 IP configuration.
2841 @end deffn
2842 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2843 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2844 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2847 Reset the current configuration.
2848 @end deffn
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2850 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2851 @end deffn
2852 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2853 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2854 pairs.
2855
2856 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2857 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2858 @example
2859 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2860 @end example
2861 @end deffn
2862 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2863 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2864 pairs.
2865
2866 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2867 @example
2868 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2869 77a90000
2870 @end example
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2873 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2874 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2875 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2876 instead.
2877
2878 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2879 @end deffn
2880 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2881 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2882 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2883
2884 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2885 @end deffn
2886 @end deffn
2887
2888 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2889 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2890 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2891 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2892 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2893 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2894 configuration script.
2895
2896 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2897 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2898 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2899 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2900 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2901
2902 Known limitations:
2903 @itemize @bullet
2904 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2905 and 2.7 MHz.
2906 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2907 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2908 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2909 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2910 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2911 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2912 communications with the target.
2913 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2914 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2915 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2916 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2917 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2918 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2919 @end itemize
2920
2921 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2922 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2923 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2927 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2928 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2929 @end deffn
2930
2931 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2932 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2933 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2934 target as a side-effect.
2935 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2939 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2940 version, and target voltage.
2941 @end deffn
2942 @end deffn
2943
2944 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2945 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2946 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2947 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2948 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2949
2950 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2951 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2952 This is a write-once setting.
2953 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2954
2955 @itemize @minus
2956 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2957 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2958 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2959 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2960 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2961 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2962 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2963 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2964 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2965 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2966 some versions of
2967 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2968 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2969 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2970 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2971 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2972 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2973 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2974 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2975 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2976 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2977 @end itemize
2978 @end deffn
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2981 Display either the address of the I/O port
2982 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2983 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2984 This is a write-once setting.
2985
2986 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2987 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2988 you may encounter a problem.
2989 @end deffn
2990
2991 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2992 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2993 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2994 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2995 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2996 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2997
2998 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2999 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3000 @quotation Tip
3001 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3002 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3003 @example
3004 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3005 > adapter speed 500
3006 @end example
3007 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3008 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3009 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3010 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3011 large set of samples.
3012 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3013 @example
3014 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3015 @end example
3016 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3017 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3018
3019 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3020 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3021 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3022 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3023 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3024 be conservative.
3025 @end quotation
3026 @end deffn
3027
3028 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3029 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3030 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3031 @end deffn
3032
3033 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3034 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3035
3036 @example
3037 adapter driver parport
3038 parport_port 0x278
3039 parport_cable wiggler
3040 @end example
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3044 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3045 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3046 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3047 @end deffn
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3051 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3052 @end deffn
3053
3054 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3055 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3059 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3060
3061 @quotation Note
3062 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3063 which are not currently documented here.
3064 @end quotation
3065 @end deffn
3066
3067 @anchor{hla_interface}
3068 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3069 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3070 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3071 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3072
3073 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3074 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3075 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3076 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3077 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3078 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3079
3080 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3081 Currently Not Supported.
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3085 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3089 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3093 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3097 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3098 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3099 @end deffn
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3104 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3105 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3106 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3107
3108 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3109 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3110 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3111 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3114 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3115
3116 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3117 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3118 @end deffn
3119
3120 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3121 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3122 @end deffn
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3126 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3130 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3134 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3135 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3136 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3137 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3138
3139 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3140 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3141 XDS110 found will be used.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3145 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3146 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3147 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3148 @end deffn
3149
3150 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3151 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3152 version).
3153 @end deffn
3154 @end deffn
3155
3156 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3157 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3158 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3159 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3160 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3161
3162 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3163
3164 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3165 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3166
3167 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3168 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3169
3170 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3171
3172 @end deffn
3173 @end deffn
3174
3175 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3176 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3177 @end deffn
3178
3179 @quotation Note
3180 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3181 which are not currently documented here.
3182 @end quotation
3183
3184 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3185 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3186 No arguments: print status.
3187 @end deffn
3188
3189 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3190 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3191 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3192
3193 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3194 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3195 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3196 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3197 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3198 configuration on exit.
3199
3200 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3201 pinout.
3202
3203 @end deffn
3204
3205 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3206 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3207 of the one which is most popular.
3208
3209 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3210
3211 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3212 pinout.
3213
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216
3217 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3218 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3219 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3220
3221 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3222 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3223 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3224
3225 @itemize @minus
3226 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3227 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3228 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3229 @end itemize
3230 @end deffn
3231
3232 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3233 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3234 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3235 @end deffn
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @section Transport Configuration
3239 @cindex Transport
3240 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3241 and the debug adapter you are using,
3242 several transports may be available to
3243 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3244 @deffn Command {transport list}
3245 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3246 version of OpenOCD.
3247 @end deffn
3248
3249 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3250 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3251
3252 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3253 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3254 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3255 adapter's driver).
3256
3257 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3258 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3259 supported by the debug adapter.
3260
3261 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3262 transport, if any.
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265 @subsection JTAG Transport
3266 @cindex JTAG
3267 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3268 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3269 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3270 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3271 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3272 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3273
3274 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3275 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3276 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3277 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3278 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3279
3280 @subsection SWD Transport
3281 @cindex SWD
3282 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3283 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3284 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3285 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3286 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3287 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3288 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3289
3290 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3291 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3292 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3293 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3294 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3295
3296 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3297 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3298 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3299 expected to change.
3300 @end deffn
3301 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3302 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3303 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3304 No parameters: displays current settings.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @subsection SPI Transport
3308 @cindex SPI
3309 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3310 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3311 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3312 solution for flash programming.
3313
3314 @anchor{swimtransport}
3315 @subsection SWIM Transport
3316 @cindex SWIM
3317 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3318 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3319 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3320 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3321
3322 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3323
3324 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3325
3326 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3327 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3328 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3329 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3330 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3331
3332 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3333 @section JTAG Speed
3334 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3335 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3336 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3337 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3338 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3339 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3340 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3341 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3342 power management software that may be active.
3343
3344 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3345 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3346 target event handler.
3347 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3348 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3349 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3350 sets up those clocks).
3351 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3352 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3353 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3354 in the target config file.
3355 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3356 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3357 config file instead.
3358 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3359 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3360 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3361
3362 @example
3363 jtag_rclk 3000
3364 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3365 @end example
3366
3367 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3368 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3369 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3370 may not be the fastest solution.
3371
3372 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3373 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3374 which support adaptive clocking.
3375
3376 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3377 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3378 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3379 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3380 than the speed specified.
3381
3382 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3383 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3384 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3385 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3386
3387 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3388 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3389 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3390 JTAG clocking after setup.
3391 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3392 If the interface device can not
3393 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3394 @end deffn
3395
3396 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3397 @cindex adaptive clocking
3398 @cindex RTCK
3399 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3400 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3401 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3402 @example
3403 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3404 jtag_rclk 3000
3405 @end example
3406 @end defun
3407
3408 @node Reset Configuration
3409 @chapter Reset Configuration
3410 @cindex Reset Configuration
3411
3412 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3413 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3414 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3415 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3416 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3417 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3418 Please see the various board files for examples.
3419
3420 @quotation Note
3421 To maintainers and integrators:
3422 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3423 Normally the board configuration file
3424 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3425 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3426
3427 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3428 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3429 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3430 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3431 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3432 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3433 @end quotation
3434
3435 @section Types of Reset
3436
3437 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3438 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3439 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3440
3441 @itemize @bullet
3442 @item
3443 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3444 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3445 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3446 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3447 @item
3448 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3449 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3450 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3451 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3452 @item
3453 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3454 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3455 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3456 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3457 @item
3458 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3459 several other types of reset.
3460 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3461 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3462 There may be individual module resets.
3463 @end itemize
3464
3465 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3466 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3467 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3468 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3469 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3470 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3471 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3472 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3473 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3474
3475 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3476 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3477
3478 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3479 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3480 common issues are:
3481
3482 @itemize @bullet
3483
3484 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3485 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3486 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3487 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3488 when either of those signals is not connected.
3489 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3490 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3491 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3492 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3493
3494 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3495 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3496 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3497 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3498
3499 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3500 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3501 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3502 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3503 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3504 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3505 hardware debouncing.
3506 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3507 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3508
3509 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3510 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3511 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3512 to use push/pull output drivers.
3513 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3514 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3515 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3516 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3517
3518 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3519 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3520 issues (not limited to errata).
3521 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3522 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3523 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3524 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3525 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3526 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3527 @end itemize
3528
3529 There can also be other issues.
3530 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3531 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3532 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3533 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3534 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3535 Agreement (NDA).
3536
3537 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3538 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3539 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3540
3541 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3542 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3543
3544 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3545
3546 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3547 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3548 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3549 allowing it to be deasserted.
3550 @end deffn
3551
3552 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3553 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3554 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3555 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3556 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3557 @end deffn
3558
3559 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3560 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3561 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3562 allowing it to be deasserted.
3563 @end deffn
3564
3565 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3566 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3567 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3568 @end deffn
3569
3570 @anchor{reset_config}
3571 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3572 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3573 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3574 configuration scripts.
3575
3576 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3577 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3578 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3579 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3580 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3581 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3582 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3583 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3584
3585 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3586 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3587 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3588 -- may be specified at a time.
3589 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3590 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3591 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3592 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3593 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3594
3595 @itemize
3596 @item
3597 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3598 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3599 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3600 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3601 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3602
3603 @quotation Tip
3604 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3605 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3606 @end quotation
3607
3608 @item
3609 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3610 signal implementations.
3611 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3612 indicating everything behaves normally.
3613 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3614 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3615 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3616 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3617 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3618 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3619 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3620
3621 @item
3622 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3623 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3624 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3625 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3626 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3627 while SRST is asserted.
3628 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3629 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3630
3631 @item
3632 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3633 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3634 is required to use this option.
3635 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3636 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3637 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3638 be asserted before any target connection.
3639 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3640 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3641 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3642 @end itemize
3643
3644 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3645 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3646 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3647 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3648 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3649
3650 @itemize
3651 @item
3652 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3653 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3654 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3655 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3656
3657 @item
3658 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3659 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3660 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3661 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3662 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3663 @end itemize
3664 @end deffn
3665
3666 @section Custom Reset Handling
3667 @cindex events
3668
3669 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3670 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3671 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3672 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3673 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3674 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3675
3676 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3677 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3678 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3679 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3680 want to reset everything at once.
3681
3682 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3683 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3684 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3685 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3686 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3687 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3688 needs special attention.
3689
3690 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3691 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3692 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3693 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3694 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3695 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3696 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3697 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3698 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3699
3700 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3701 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3702 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3703 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3704 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3705
3706 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3707 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3708 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3709 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3710 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3711 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3712 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3713 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3714 or potentially some other value.
3715
3716 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3717 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3718 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3719 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3720 (or their associated targets)
3721 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3722
3723 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3724 they return.
3725 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3726 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3727 @end deffn
3728
3729 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3730 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3731 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3732 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3733 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3734 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3735 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3736 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3737 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3738 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3739 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3740 @end deffn
3741
3742 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3743 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3744 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3745 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3746 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3747 @end deffn
3748
3749
3750 @node TAP Declaration
3751 @chapter TAP Declaration
3752 @cindex TAP declaration
3753 @cindex TAP configuration
3754
3755 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3756 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3757
3758 @itemize @bullet
3759 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3760 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3761 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3762 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3763 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3764 start running that code.
3765 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3766 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3767 and missing connections.
3768 @end itemize
3769
3770 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3771 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3772 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3773 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3774 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3775
3776 @section Scan Chains
3777 @cindex scan chain
3778
3779 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3780 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3781 They also need to be added to
3782 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3783 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3784 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3785 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3786 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3787 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3788 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3789 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3790
3791 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3792 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3793 command, presented in the next chapter.
3794 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3795 debugging targets.)
3796 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3797
3798 @verbatim
3799 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3800 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3801 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3802 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3803 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3804 @end verbatim
3805
3806 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3807 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3808 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3809 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3810 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3811 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3812 until they are told to do so.
3813
3814 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3815 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3816 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3817 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3818
3819 @example
3820 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3821 @end example
3822
3823 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3824 by a given chip.
3825 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3826 and so forth.
3827 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3828 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3829 both inside a single chip and between them.
3830 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3831
3832 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3833 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3834 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3835 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3836 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3837 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3838 includes commands something like this:
3839
3840 @example
3841 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3842 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3843 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3844 @end example
3845
3846 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3847 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3848 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3849
3850 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3851 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3852 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3853 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3854 @example
3855 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3856 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3857 @}
3858 @end example
3859 @end deffn
3860
3861 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3862 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3863 and their status.
3864 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3865 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3866 but systems with a JTAG router can
3867 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3868 @end deffn
3869
3870 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3871 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3872
3873 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3874 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3875
3876 @section TAP Names
3877 @cindex dotted name
3878
3879 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3880 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3881 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3882 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3883 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3884 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3885 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3886 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3887
3888 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3889 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3890 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3891
3892 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3893
3894 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3895 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3896 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3897 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3898
3899 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3900 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3901 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3902 overridable.
3903
3904 @cindex TAP naming convention
3905 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3906 and should follow this convention:
3907
3908 @itemize @bullet
3909 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3910 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3911 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3912 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3913 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3914 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3915 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3916 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3917 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3918 with a single TAP;
3919 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3920 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3921 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3922 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3923 @end itemize
3924
3925 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3926
3927 @itemize @bullet
3928 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3929 @*The length in bits of the
3930 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3931 @end itemize
3932
3933 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3934
3935 @itemize @bullet
3936 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3937 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3938 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3939 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3940 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3941 (the TAP is linked in).
3942 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3943 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3944 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3945 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3946 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3947 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3948 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3949 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3950 values that were found but not included in the list.
3951
3952 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3953 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3954 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3955 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3956 hardware to find these values.
3957 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3958 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3959 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3960 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3961 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3962 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3963 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3964 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3965 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3966 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3967 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3968 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3969 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3970 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3971 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3972 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3973 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3974 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3975 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3976 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3977 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3978 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3979 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3980 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3981 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3982 @end itemize
3983 @end deffn
3984
3985 @section Other TAP commands
3986
3987 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3988 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3989 @end deffn
3990
3991 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3992 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3993 At this writing this TAP attribute
3994 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3995 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3996 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3997 See the next section for information about the available events.
3998
3999 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4000 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4001 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4002 @end deffn
4003
4004 @section TAP Events
4005 @cindex events
4006 @cindex TAP events
4007
4008 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4009 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4010 The other applies to debugger targets,
4011 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4012
4013 The TAP events currently defined are:
4014
4015 @itemize @bullet
4016 @item @b{post-reset}
4017 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4018 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4019 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4020 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4021 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4022
4023 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4024 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4025 of any particular target.
4026 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4027 @item @b{setup}
4028 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4029 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4030 @item @b{tap-disable}
4031 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4032 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4033 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4034 @item @b{tap-enable}
4035 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4036 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4037 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4038 @end itemize
4039
4040 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4041 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4042 contents to be accurate), you might:
4043
4044 @example
4045 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4046 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4047 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4048 @}
4049 @end example
4050
4051
4052 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4053 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4054 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4055 @cindex jrc
4056
4057 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4058 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4059 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4060 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4061 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4062
4063 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4064 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4065 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4066 be visible.
4067 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4068 ignores, such as:
4069
4070 @itemize
4071 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4072 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4073 TAPs receive new instructions.
4074 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4075 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4076 @end itemize
4077
4078 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4079 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4080 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4081 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4082
4083 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4084 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4085
4086 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4087 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4088 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4089 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4090 should define TAP event handlers using
4091 code that looks something like this:
4092
4093 @example
4094 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4095 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4096 @}
4097 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4098 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4099 @}
4100 @end example
4101
4102 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4103
4104 @example
4105 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4106 @end example
4107
4108 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4109 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4110 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4111 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4112
4113 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4114 If necessary, disables the tap
4115 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4116 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4117 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4118 and "0" if it is disabled.
4119 @end deffn
4120
4121 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4122 If necessary, enables the tap
4123 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4124 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4125 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4126 and "0" if it is disabled.
4127 @end deffn
4128
4129 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4130 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4131 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4132 and "0" if it is disabled.
4133
4134 @quotation Note
4135 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4136 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4137 @end quotation
4138 @end deffn
4139
4140 @anchor{autoprobing}
4141 @section Autoprobing
4142 @cindex autoprobe
4143 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4144
4145 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4146 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4147 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4148 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4149
4150 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4151 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4152 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4153 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4154 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4155 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4156 right when they come out of reset).
4157
4158 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4159
4160 @example
4161 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4162 reset_config trst_and_srst
4163 jtag_rclk 8
4164 @end example
4165
4166 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4167 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4168
4169 @enumerate
4170 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4171 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4172 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4173 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4174 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4175 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4176 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4177 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4178 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4179 that is discovered.
4180 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4181 register, it will report it.
4182 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4183 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4184 @end enumerate
4185
4186 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4187 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4188 that's a bit more complex:
4189
4190 @example
4191 clock speed 8 kHz
4192 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4193 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4194 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4195 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4196 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4197 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4198 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4199 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4200 @end example
4201
4202 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4203 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4204 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4205 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4206 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4207 and so forth.
4208
4209 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4210 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4211 @cindex DAP declaration
4212
4213 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4214 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4215 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4216 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4217 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4218
4219 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4220
4221 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4222 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4223 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4224 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4225 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4226
4227 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4228
4229 @itemize @bullet
4230 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4231 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4232 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4233 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4234 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4235 @end itemize
4236 @end deffn
4237
4238 @deffn Command {dap names}
4239 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4240 for TCL scripting.
4241 @end deffn
4242
4243 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4244 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4245 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4246 @end deffn
4247
4248 @deffn Command {dap init}
4249 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4250 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4251 initialization, too.
4252 @end deffn
4253
4254 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4255
4256 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4257 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4258 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4259 @end deffn
4260
4261 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4262 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4263 @end deffn
4264
4265 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4266 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4267 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4268 or set a new value @var{value}.
4269 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4273 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4274 @end deffn
4275
4276 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4277 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4278 value @var{value}.
4279
4280 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4281 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4282 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4283
4284 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4285 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4289 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4290 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4291 @end deffn
4292
4293 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4294 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4295 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4296 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4297 @end deffn
4298
4299 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4300 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4301
4302 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4303 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4304 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4305 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4306 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4307 for details.
4308
4309 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4310 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4311 the pattern:
4312 @example
4313 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4314 @end example
4315
4316 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4317 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4318 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4319 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4320 @example
4321 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4322 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4323 @end example
4324
4325 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4326 @example
4327 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4328 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4329 @end example
4330
4331 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4332 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4333
4334 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4335 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4336 example with a proper dap name:
4337 @example
4338 xxx.dap apcsw default
4339 @end example
4340 @end deffn
4341
4342 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4343 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4344 Disabled by default
4345 @end deffn
4346
4347
4348 @node CPU Configuration
4349 @chapter CPU Configuration
4350 @cindex GDB target
4351
4352 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4353 You can also access these targets without GDB
4354 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4355 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4356 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4357 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4358
4359 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4360 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4361
4362 @section Target List
4363 @cindex target, current
4364 @cindex target, list
4365
4366 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4367 where each member has a name.
4368 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4369 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4370 (plural!) command.
4371 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4372 look like with more than one:
4373 @verbatim
4374 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4375 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4376 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4377 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4378 @end verbatim
4379
4380 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4381 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4382 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4383 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4384 space seen by that current target.
4385 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4386 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4387 are examples; and there are many more.
4388
4389 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4390
4391 @deffn Command {target current}
4392 Returns the name of the current target.
4393 @end deffn
4394
4395 @deffn Command {target names}
4396 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4397 @example
4398 foreach t [target names] @{
4399 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4400 @}
4401 @end example
4402 @end deffn
4403
4404 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4405 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4406
4407 @deffn Command targets [name]
4408 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4409 command names are singular.}
4410
4411 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4412 targets in a user friendly form.
4413
4414 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4415 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4416 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4417 @end deffn
4418
4419 @section Target CPU Types
4420 @cindex target type
4421 @cindex CPU type
4422
4423 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4424 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4425 when calling @command{target create}.
4426 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4427 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4428 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4429 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4430 what core-specific commands may be available
4431 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4432 and more.
4433
4434 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4435 since there's a command to list them.
4436
4437 @anchor{targettypes}
4438 @deffn Command {target types}
4439 Lists all supported target types.
4440 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4441
4442 @itemize @bullet
4443 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4444 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4445 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4446 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4447 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4448 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4449 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4450 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4451 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4452 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4453 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4454 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4455 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4456 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4457 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4458 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4459 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4460 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4461 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4462 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4463 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4464 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4465 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4466 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4467 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4468 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4469 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4470 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4471 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4472 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4473 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4474 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4475 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4476 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4477 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4478 @itemize @minus
4479 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4480 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4481 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4482 @end itemize
4483 And two debug interfaces cores:
4484 @itemize @minus
4485 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4486 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4487 @end itemize
4488 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4489 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4490 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4491 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4492 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4493 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4494 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4495 @end itemize
4496 @end deffn
4497
4498 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4499 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4500 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4501 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4502 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4503 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4504 reflect design generations;
4505 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4506 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4507
4508 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4509 @section Target Configuration
4510
4511 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4512 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4513 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4514 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4515 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4516
4517 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4518 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4519 optional parts.
4520 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4521 command, created as part of target creation.
4522
4523 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4524 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4525 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4526 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4527 to be much more board-specific.
4528 The key steps you use might look something like this
4529
4530 @example
4531 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4532 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4533 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4534 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4535 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4536 @end example
4537
4538 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4539 on-chip SRAM.
4540 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4541 writes to target memory;
4542 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4543 GDB memory checksumming;
4544 and more.
4545
4546 @quotation Warning
4547 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4548 inaccessible when application code
4549 (such as an operating system)
4550 enables or disables the MMU.
4551 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4552 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4553 easy access to other addresses needed.
4554 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4555 @end quotation
4556
4557 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4558 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4559 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4560 controllers.
4561 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4562 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4563 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4564
4565 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4566 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4567 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4568 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4569 purposes including additional configuration.
4570
4571 @itemize @bullet
4572 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4573 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4574 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4575 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4576
4577 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4578 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4579 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4580 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4581 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4582 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4583 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4584
4585 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4586 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4587 @end itemize
4588 @end deffn
4589
4590 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4591 The options accepted by this command may also be
4592 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4593 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4594 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4595
4596 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4597 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4598 and changing its endianness.
4599
4600 @itemize @bullet
4601
4602 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4603 used to access this target.
4604
4605 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4606 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4607 create and manage DAP instances.
4608
4609 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4610 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4611
4612 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4613 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4614 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4615 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4616 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4617 same event name assigns only one handler.
4618
4619 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4620 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4621
4622 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4623 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4624 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4625 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4626 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4627 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4628 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4629
4630 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4631 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4632 or virtual address is being used.
4633
4634 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4635 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4636
4637 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4638 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4639 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4640 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4641 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4642
4643 @anchor{rtostype}
4644 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4645 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4646 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4647 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4648 @option{RIOT}
4649 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4650
4651 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4652 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4653 access the target for debugging.
4654
4655 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4656 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4657 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4658 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4659
4660 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4661 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4662 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4663 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4664 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4665
4666 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4667 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4668 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4669 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4670 command @command{gdb_port}.
4671 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4672 @end itemize
4673 @end deffn
4674
4675 @section Other $target_name Commands
4676 @cindex object command
4677
4678 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4679 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4680
4681 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4682 Once a button is created a button
4683 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4684 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4685 configure it like this:
4686
4687 @example
4688 # Create
4689 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4690 # Modify
4691 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4692 # Query
4693 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4694 # Report
4695 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4696 @end example
4697
4698 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4699 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4700
4701 @example
4702 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4703 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4704 @end example
4705
4706 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4707
4708 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4709 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4710 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4711 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4712 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4713 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4714 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4715 They are not otherwise documented here.
4716 @end deffn
4717
4718 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4719 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4720 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4721 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4722 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4723 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4724 the target side uses raw memory.
4725
4726 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4727 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4728 The script orientation comes from working with data
4729 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4730 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4731 and neither store nor return those values.
4732
4733 @itemize
4734 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4735 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4736 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4737 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4738 @end itemize
4739 @end deffn
4740
4741 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4742 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4743 @command{$target_name configure}
4744 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4745 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4746 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4747 There are a few special cases:
4748
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4751 event named @var{event_name}.
4752 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4753 two parameters.
4754 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4755 This is a special case because this is set using
4756 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4757 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4758 @end itemize
4759
4760 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4761 all the targets you might use something like this:
4762
4763 @example
4764 foreach name [target names] @{
4765 set y [$name cget -endian]
4766 set z [$name cget -type]
4767 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4768 $x $name $y $z]
4769 @}
4770 @end example
4771 @end deffn
4772
4773 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4774 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4775 Displays the current target state:
4776 @code{debug-running},
4777 @code{halted},
4778 @code{reset},
4779 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4780 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4781 @end deffn
4782
4783 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4784 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4785 currently associated with this target.
4786 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4787 @end deffn
4788
4789 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4790 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4791 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4792 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4793 @end deffn
4794
4795 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4796 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4797 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4798 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4799 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4800 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4801 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4802 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4803 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4804 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4805 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4806 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4807 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4808 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4809 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4810 @end deffn
4811
4812 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4813 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4814 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4815 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4816 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4817 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4818 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4819 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4820 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4821 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4822 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4823 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4824 @end deffn
4825
4826 @anchor{targetevents}
4827 @section Target Events
4828 @cindex target events
4829 @cindex events
4830 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4831 For example:
4832 @itemize @bullet
4833 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4834 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4835 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4836 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4837 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4838 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4839 to set up system clocks or
4840 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4841 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4842 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4843 @end itemize
4844
4845 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4846 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4847 @command{target create ... -event}.
4848
4849 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4850 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4851 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4852
4853 @example
4854 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4855 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4856 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4857 @}
4858 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4859 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4860 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4861 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4862 @}
4863 @end example
4864
4865 The following target events are defined:
4866
4867 @itemize @bullet
4868 @item @b{debug-halted}
4869 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4870 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4871 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4872 @item @b{early-halted}
4873 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4874 @item @b{examine-start}
4875 @* Before target examine is called.
4876 @item @b{examine-end}
4877 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4878 @item @b{examine-fail}
4879 @* After target examine fails.
4880 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4881 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4882 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4883 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4884 connect GDB to running target.
4885 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4886 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4887 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4888 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4889 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4890 is in RAM or read only memory.
4891 Default is @code{halt}
4892 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4893 @* When GDB disconnects
4894 @item @b{gdb-end}
4895 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4896 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4897 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4898 @code{reset init})
4899 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4900 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4901 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4902 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4903 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4904 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4905 @item @b{gdb-start}
4906 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4907 @item @b{halted}
4908 @* The target has halted
4909 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4910 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4911 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4912 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4913 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4914 @item @b{reset-assert}
4915 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4916 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4917 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4918 it instead of asserting SRST.
4919 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4920 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4921 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4922 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4923 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4924 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4925 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4926 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4927 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4928 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4929 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4930 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4931 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4932 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4933 released on the scan chain.
4934 @item @b{reset-end}
4935 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4936 @item @b{reset-init}
4937 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4938 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4939
4940 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4941 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4942 multiplexing, and so on.
4943 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4944 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4945 @item @b{reset-start}
4946 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4947 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4948
4949 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4950 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4951 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4952 @item @b{resume-start}
4953 @* Before any target is resumed
4954 @item @b{resume-end}
4955 @* After all targets have resumed
4956 @item @b{resumed}
4957 @* Target has resumed
4958 @item @b{step-start}
4959 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4960 @item @b{step-end}
4961 @* After single-step has completed
4962 @item @b{trace-config}
4963 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4964 @end itemize
4965
4966 @node Flash Commands
4967 @chapter Flash Commands
4968
4969 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4970 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4971 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4972 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4973 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4974 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4975 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4976 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4977 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4978
4979 Flash Steps:
4980 @enumerate
4981 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4982 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4983 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4984 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4985 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4986 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4987 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4988 @item GDB Flashing
4989 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4990 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4991 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4992 @end enumerate
4993
4994 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4995 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4996 so that it can't boot.
4997 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4998 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4999
5000 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5001 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5002 @cindex flash configuration
5003
5004 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5005 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5006 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5007 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5008 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5009 see the driver-specific documentation.
5010
5011 @itemize @bullet
5012 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5013 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5014 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5015 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5016 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5017 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5018 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5019 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5020 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5021 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5022 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5023 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5024 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5025 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5026 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5027 commands to the flash controller.
5028 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5029 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5030 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5031 for more information.
5032 @end itemize
5033 @quotation Note
5034 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5035 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5036 @end quotation
5037 @end deffn
5038
5039 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5040 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5041 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5042 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5043 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5044 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5045 @end deffn
5046
5047 @deffn Command {flash list}
5048 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5049 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5050 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5051 @end deffn
5052
5053 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5054 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5055 depends on the flash type.
5056 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5057 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5058 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5059 but most don't bother.
5060 @end deffn
5061
5062 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5063
5064 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5065 begins.
5066
5067 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5068 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5069 until the programming session is finished.
5070
5071 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5072 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5073
5074 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5075
5076 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5077 @cindex flash erasing
5078 @cindex flash reading
5079 @cindex flash writing
5080 @cindex flash programming
5081 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5082
5083 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5084 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5085 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5086 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5087 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5088
5089 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5090 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5091 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5092 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5093 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5094
5095 @quotation Note
5096 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5097 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5098 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5099 back to a flash bank.
5100 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5101 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5102 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5103 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5104 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5105 @end quotation
5106
5107 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5108 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5109 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5110 disabled first.
5111 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5112 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5113 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5114
5115 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5116 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5117 up to and including @var{last}.
5118 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5119 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5120 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5121 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5122 @end deffn
5123
5124 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5125 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5126 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5127 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5128 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5129 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5130 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5131 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5132 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5133 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5134 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5135 before erase starts.
5136 @end deffn
5137
5138 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5139 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5140 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5141 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5142 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5143 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5144 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5145 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5146 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5147 before issuing this command.
5148 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5149 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5150 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5151 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5152 @end deffn
5153 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5154
5155 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5156 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5157 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5158 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5159 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5160 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5161 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5162 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5163 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5164 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5165 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5166 @end deffn
5167
5168 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5169 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5170 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5171 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5172 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5173 @end deffn
5174
5175 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5176 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5177 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5178 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5179 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5180 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5181 @end deffn
5182
5183 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5184 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5185 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5186 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5187 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5188 @end deffn
5189
5190 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5191 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5192 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5193 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5194 to the base address for each section in the image.
5195 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5196 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5197 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5198 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5199 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5200 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5201 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5202 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5203 each image section.
5204
5205 @quotation Warning
5206 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5207 data you want to preserve.
5208 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5209 sections might be erased with no notice.
5210 @itemize
5211 @item
5212 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5213 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5214 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5215 @item
5216 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5217 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5218 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5219 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5220 @end itemize
5221 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5222 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5223 @end quotation
5224
5225 @end deffn
5226
5227 @section Other Flash commands
5228 @cindex flash protection
5229
5230 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5231 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5232 and display that status.
5233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5237 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5238 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5239
5240 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5241 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5242 and possibly stale information.
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @anchor{flashprotect}
5246 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5247 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5248 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5249 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5250 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5251 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5253 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5254 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5255 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5259 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5260 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5261 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @anchor{program}
5265 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5266 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5267 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5268 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5269 @end deffn
5270
5271 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5272 @section Flash Driver List
5273 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5274 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5275 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5276
5277 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5278 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5279 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5280
5281 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5282
5283 @itemize
5284 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5285 @end itemize
5286
5287 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5288 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5289 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5290 @example
5291 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5292 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5293 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5294 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5295 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5296 @end example
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @subsection External Flash
5300
5301 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5302 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5303 @cindex CFI
5304 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5305 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5306 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5307 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5308 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5309 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5310 configure a bus and its timings), or
5311 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5312 on the flash chip.
5313 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5314 speed up operation.
5315
5316 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5317
5318 @itemize
5319 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5320 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5321 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5322 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5323 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5324 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5325 @end itemize
5326
5327 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5328 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5329
5330 @example
5331 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5333 @end example
5334
5335 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5336 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5337 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5338
5339 @example
5340 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5341 @end example
5342
5343 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5344 @end deffn
5345
5346 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5347 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5348 @cindex SPI
5349 @cindex jtagspi
5350 @cindex bscan_spi
5351 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5352 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5353 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5354 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5355 accessed through JTAG.
5356
5357 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5358 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5359 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5360 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5361 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5362 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5363
5364 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5365 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5366 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5367 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5368 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5369 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5370 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5371 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5372
5373 @itemize
5374 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5375 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5376 @var{USER1} instruction.
5377 @end itemize
5378
5379 @example
5380 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5381 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5382 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5383 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5384 @end example
5385 @end deffn
5386
5387 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5388 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5389 @cindex xcf
5390 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5391 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5392 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5393 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5394 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5395
5396 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5397 command accepts additional parameters:
5398 @itemize
5399 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5400 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5401 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5402 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5403 in master mode.
5404 @end itemize
5405 @example
5406 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5407 @end example
5408 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5409 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5410 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5411 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5412 dedicated sector.
5413 @end deffn
5414
5415 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5416 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5417 button.
5418 @example
5419 xcf configure 0
5420 @end example
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 Additional driver notes:
5424 @itemize
5425 @item Only single revision supported.
5426 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5427 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5428 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5429 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5430 @end itemize
5431 @end deffn
5432
5433 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5434 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5435 @cindex SPIFI
5436 @cindex lpcspifi
5437 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5438 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5439 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5440
5441 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5442 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5443 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5444 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5445 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5446
5447 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5448 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5449 are configured by the driver.
5450
5451 @example
5452 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5453 @end example
5454
5455 @end deffn
5456
5457 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5458 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5459 @cindex SMI
5460 @cindex stmsmi
5461 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5462 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5463 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5464 SPI flash devices.
5465 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5466 flash devices can be connected.
5467
5468 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5469 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5470 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5471 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5472 the flash content.
5473
5474 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5475 to identify the memory bank.
5476 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5477 flash size, are detected automatically.
5478
5479 @example
5480 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5481 @end example
5482
5483 @end deffn
5484
5485 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5486 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5487 Microcontroller platform.
5488
5489 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5490 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5491
5492 @example
5493 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5494 @end example
5495
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5499 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5500 @cindex ath79
5501 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5502 chip selects.
5503 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5504 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5505 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5506 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5507 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5508 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5509
5510 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5511 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5512 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5513 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5514 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5515 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5516 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5517 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5518 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5519 with the default CS0.
5520 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5521 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5522 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5523
5524 @example
5525 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5526
5527 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5528 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5529 # banks.
5530 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5531 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5532 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5533 @end example
5534
5535 @end deffn
5536
5537 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5538 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5539 @cindex fespi
5540
5541 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5542
5543 @example
5544 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5545 @end example
5546 @end deffn
5547
5548 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5549
5550 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5551 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5552 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5553 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5554 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5555 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5556
5557 @example
5558 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5559 @end example
5560 @end deffn
5561
5562 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5563 @cindex ambiqmicro
5564 @cindex apollo
5565 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5566 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5567 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5568 with the target using SWD.
5569
5570 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5571 the device class of the MCU.
5572 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5573 to set up the flash banks.
5574 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5575 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5576
5577 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5578 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5579 and the second bank starts after the first.
5580
5581 @example
5582 # Flash bank 0
5583 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5584 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5585 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5586 $_TARGETNAME
5587 @end example
5588
5589 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5590 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5591 are available to the user.
5592
5593 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5594
5595 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5596 Erase entire bank.
5597 @end deffn
5598 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5599 Erase device pages.
5600 @end deffn
5601 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5602 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5603 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5604 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5605 the flash.
5606 @end deffn
5607 @end deffn
5608
5609 @anchor{at91samd}
5610 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5611 @cindex at91samd
5612 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5613 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5614
5615 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5616
5617 The devices have one flash bank:
5618
5619 @example
5620 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5621 @end example
5622
5623 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5624 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5625 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5626 processor to be halted.
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5630 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5631 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5632 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5633 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5634 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5635
5636 @example
5637 at91samd set-security enable
5638 @end example
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5642 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5643 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5644 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5645 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5646 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5647 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5648 in order to disable this feature.
5649
5650 @example
5651 at91samd eeprom
5652 at91samd eeprom 1024
5653 @end example
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5657 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5658 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5659 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5660 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5661 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5662
5663 @example
5664 at91samd bootloader
5665 at91samd bootloader 16384
5666 @end example
5667 @end deffn
5668
5669 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5670 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5671 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5672 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5673 @end deffn
5674
5675 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5676 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5677 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5678 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5679 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5680 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5681 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5682 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5683
5684 @example
5685 # Read user row
5686 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5687 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5688 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5689 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5690 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5691 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5692 @end example
5693 @end deffn
5694
5695 @end deffn
5696
5697 @anchor{at91sam3}
5698 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5699 @cindex at91sam3
5700 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5701 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5702 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5703 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5704 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5705 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5706 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5707 chips are confirmed.}
5708
5709 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5710 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5711 the following fixed locations:
5712
5713 @example
5714 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5715 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5716 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5717 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5718 @end example
5719
5720 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5721 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5722 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5723
5724 @itemize
5725 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5726 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5727 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5728 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5729 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5730 @end itemize
5731
5732 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5733
5734 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5735 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5736 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5737 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5738 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5739 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5740 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5741
5742 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5743 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5744 @end deffn
5745
5746 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5747 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5748 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5749 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5750 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5751 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5752 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5753 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5757 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5758 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5759 @end deffn
5760 @end deffn
5761
5762 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5763 @cindex at91sam4
5764 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5765 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5766 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5767 @end deffn
5768
5769 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5770 @cindex at91sam4l
5771 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5772 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5773 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5774
5775 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5776 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5777 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5778 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5779 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5780 @end deffn
5781 @end deffn
5782
5783 @anchor{atsame5}
5784 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5785 @cindex atsame5
5786 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5787 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5788 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5789
5790 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5791 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5792 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5793
5794 @example
5795 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5796 @end example
5797
5798 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5799 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5800 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5801 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5802 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5803 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5804
5805 @example
5806 atsame5 bootloader
5807 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5808 @end example
5809 @end deffn
5810
5811 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5812 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5813 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5814 processor to be halted.
5815 @end deffn
5816
5817 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5818 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5819 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5820 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5824 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5825 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5826 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5827 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5828 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5829 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5830 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5831
5832 @example
5833 # Read
5834 >atsame5 userpage
5835 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5836 # Write
5837 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5838 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5839 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5840 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5841 @end example
5842 @end deffn
5843
5844 @end deffn
5845
5846 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5847 @cindex atsamv
5848 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5849 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5850 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5851 @end deffn
5852
5853 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5854 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5855 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5856 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5857 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5858
5859 @example
5860 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5861 @end example
5862
5863 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5864 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5865
5866 @itemize
5867 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5868 @item @var{banks}
5869 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5870 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5871 @item @var{pages_size}
5872 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5873 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5874 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5875 @end itemize
5876
5877 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5878 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5879 will be autoconfigured.
5880 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5881
5882 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5883 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5884 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5885 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5886 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5887
5888 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5889 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5890 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5891 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5892 are not truly general purpose).
5893 @quotation Note
5894 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5895 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5896 @end quotation
5897 @end deffn
5898 @end deffn
5899
5900 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5901 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5902 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5903 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5904 @end deffn
5905
5906 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5907 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5908 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5909 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5910
5911 @example
5912 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5913 @end example
5914
5915 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5916 each single sector one by one.
5917
5918 @example
5919 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5920 @end example
5921
5922 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5923 @end deffn
5924
5925 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5926 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5927 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5928 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5929 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5930 starts at address 0.
5931
5932 @example
5933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5934 @end example
5935 @end deffn
5936
5937 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5938 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5939 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5940 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5941 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5942 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5943 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5944 and programming the serial flash.
5945
5946 @example
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5948 @end example
5949 @end deffn
5950
5951 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5952 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5953 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5954 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5955 autoconfigures itself.
5956 @example
5957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5958 @end example
5959 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5960 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5961 this via the following command:
5962 @example
5963 efm32 debuglock num
5964 @end example
5965 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5966 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5967 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5968 supported.}
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5972 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5973 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5974 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5975 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5976 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5977
5978 @example
5979 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5980 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5981 @end example
5982
5983 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5984 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5988 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5989 is an uncommon operation.}
5990 @end deffn
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5994 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5995 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5996 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5997 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5998 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5999 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6000
6001 @example
6002 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6003 @end example
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6007 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6008 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6009 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6010 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6011 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6012 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6013 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6014 characters) ignored.
6015
6016 @example
6017 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6018 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6019 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6020 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6021 @end example
6022 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6023 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6024 @end deffn
6025
6026 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6027 @cindex kinetis
6028 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6029 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6030 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6031 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6032 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6033 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6034
6035 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6036 @itemize
6037 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6038 @end itemize
6039
6040 @example
6041 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6042 @end example
6043
6044 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6045 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6046 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6047 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6051 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6052 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6053 set by 'flash protect' command.
6054 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6055 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6056 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6057 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6058 with the rest of a flash image.
6059 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6060 @end deffn
6061
6062 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6063 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6064 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6065 @end deffn
6066
6067 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6068 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6069 and examine-fail event.
6070 @end deffn
6071
6072 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6073 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6074 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6075 @end deffn
6076
6077 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6078 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6079 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6080 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6081 command completes.
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6085 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6086 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6087 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6088 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6089
6090 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6091 Program Partition command.
6092
6093 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6094 Reset the device after partition setting.
6095
6096 Show partition size:
6097 @example
6098 kinetis nvm_partition info
6099 @end example
6100
6101 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6102 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6103 @example
6104 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6105 @end example
6106
6107 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6108 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6109 @example
6110 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6111 @end example
6112 @end deffn
6113
6114 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6115 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6116 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6117 @end deffn
6118
6119 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6120 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6121 Command disables watchdog timer.
6122 @end deffn
6123 @end deffn
6124
6125 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6126 @cindex kinetis_ke
6127 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6128 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6129 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6130 autoconfigures itself.
6131 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6132
6133 @example
6134 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6135 @end example
6136
6137 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6138 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6139 @end deffn
6140
6141 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6142 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6143 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6144 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6145 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6146 @end deffn
6147
6148 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6149 Command disables watchdog timer.
6150 @end deffn
6151 @end deffn
6152
6153 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6154 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6155 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6156 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6157 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6158
6159 @quotation Note
6160 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6161 driver:
6162 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6163 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6164 @end quotation
6165
6166 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6167 which must appear in the following order:
6168
6169 @itemize
6170 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6171 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6172 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6173 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6174 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6175 LPC43x[2357])
6176 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6177 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6178 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6179 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6180 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6181 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6182 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6183 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6184 at which the core is running
6185 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6186 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6187 @quotation Note
6188 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6189 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6190 However, if you do provide it,
6191 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6192 @end quotation
6193 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6194 ROM IAP entry point.
6195 @end itemize
6196
6197 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6198
6199 @example
6200 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6201 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6202 @end example
6203
6204 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6205 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6206 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6207 @end deffn
6208 @end deffn
6209
6210 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6211 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6212 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6213 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6214 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6215 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6216
6217 @example
6218 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6219 @end example
6220 @end deffn
6221
6222 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6223 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6224 from NXP.
6225
6226 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6227 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6228 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6229 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6230 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6231 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6232 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6233 you start the PLL.
6234
6235 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6236
6237 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6238 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6239 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6240
6241 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6242 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6243 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6244 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6245 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6246 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6247 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6248
6249 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6250 @example
6251 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6252 @end example
6253
6254 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6255 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6256 @code{flash banks} command.
6257
6258 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6259 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6260 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6261 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6262 a known signature.
6263 Example:
6264 @example
6265 lpc2900 signature 0
6266 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6267 @end example
6268 @end deffn
6269
6270 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6271 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6272 saves it to a file in binary format.
6273 Example:
6274 @example
6275 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6276 @end example
6277 @end deffn
6278
6279 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6280 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6281 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6282 command:
6283
6284 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6285 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6286 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6287 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6288
6289 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6290 Example:
6291 @example
6292 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6293 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6294 @end example
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6298 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6299 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6300 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6301 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6302 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6303 912 bytes.
6304 @quotation Attention
6305 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6306 @end quotation
6307 Example:
6308 @example
6309 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6310 @end example
6311 @end deffn
6312
6313 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6314 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6315 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6316 after the next power cycle.
6317 @quotation Attention
6318 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6319 @end quotation
6320 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6321 Example:
6322 @example
6323 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6324 flash info 0
6325 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6326 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6327 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6328 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6329 @end example
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6333 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6334 effective after the next power cycle.
6335 @quotation Attention
6336 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6337 @end quotation
6338 Examples:
6339 @example
6340 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6341 @end example
6342 @end deffn
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6346 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6347 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6348 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6349
6350 @example
6351 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6352 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6353 @end example
6354
6355 @itemize @bullet
6356 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6357 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6358 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6359 @end itemize
6360
6361 Example usage:
6362 @example
6363 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6364 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6365 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6366 @} else @{
6367 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6368 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6369 @}
6370 @end example
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6374 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6375 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6376 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6377 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6378 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6379
6380 @example
6381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6382 @end example
6383
6384 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6385 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6386 only the main program flash.
6387
6388 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6389 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6390 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6391 @end deffn
6392
6393 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6394 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6395 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6396 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6397
6398 To erase and program the BSL:
6399 @example
6400 msp432 bsl unlock
6401 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6402 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6403 msp432 bsl lock
6404 @end example
6405 @end deffn
6406 @end deffn
6407
6408 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6409 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6410 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6411 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6412 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6413 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6414 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6415 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6416 also have division into regions: main and info.
6417 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6418 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6419
6420 @example
6421 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6422 @end example
6423
6424 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6425
6426 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6427 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6428 @end deffn
6429
6430 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6431 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6432 @end deffn
6433
6434 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6435 Erase all userflash including info region.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6439 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6443 Check sectors protect.
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6447 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6451 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6452 @end deffn
6453
6454 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6455 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6459 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6460 @end deffn
6461
6462 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6463 Show information about flash driver.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @end deffn
6467
6468 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6469 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6470 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6471 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6472 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6473
6474 @example
6475 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6476 @end example
6477
6478 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6479
6480 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6481 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6482 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6483 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6484 code.
6485 @end deffn
6486
6487 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6488 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6489 @end deffn
6490
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6494 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6495 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6496
6497 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6498 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6499 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6500 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6501
6502 @example
6503 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6504 @end example
6505 @end deffn
6506
6507 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6508 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6509 and integrate flash memory.
6510
6511 @example
6512 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6513 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6514 @end example
6515
6516 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6517 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6518 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6519 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6520 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6521 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6522 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6523 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6524 @end deffn
6525 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6526 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6527 This will remove any Code Protection.
6528 @end deffn
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6532 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6533 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6534 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6535 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6536
6537 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6538 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6539
6540 @example
6541 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6542 @end example
6543
6544 psoc4-specific commands
6545 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6546 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6547
6548 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6549 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6550
6551 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6552 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6553 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6554
6555 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6559 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6560
6561 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6562 @end deffn
6563 @end deffn
6564
6565 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6566 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6567 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6568 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6569 apart from the base address.
6570
6571 @example
6572 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6573 @end example
6574
6575 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6576 @quotation Attention
6577 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6578 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6579 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6580 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6581 @end quotation
6582
6583 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6584
6585 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6586 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6587 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6588 @end deffn
6589 @end deffn
6590
6591 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6592 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6593 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6594 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6595 apart from the base address.
6596
6597 @example
6598 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6599 @end example
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6603 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6604 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6605 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6606
6607 @example
6608 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6609 @end example
6610
6611 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6612
6613 @itemize
6614 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6615 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6616 @end itemize
6617
6618 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6619
6620 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6621 @quotation Attention
6622 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6623 after successful write.
6624 @end quotation
6625 @end deffn
6626
6627 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6628 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6629 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6630 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6631
6632 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6633 @itemize @bullet
6634 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6635 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6636 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6637 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6638 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6639 row size: 512 bytes.
6640 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6641 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6642 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6643 operation will erase row automatically.
6644 @end itemize
6645
6646 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6647 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6648
6649 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6650
6651 @example
6652 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6653 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6654 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6655 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6656 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6657 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6658
6659 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6660 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6661 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6662 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6663 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6664 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6665 @end example
6666
6667 psoc6-specific commands
6668 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6669 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6670 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6671 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6672 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6673 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6674 @end deffn
6675
6676 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6677 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6678 by @command{flash banks}.
6679 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6680 @end deffn
6681 @end deffn
6682
6683 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6684 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6685 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6686 and SWD interface.
6687 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6688 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6689
6690 @example
6691 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6692 @end example
6693
6694 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6695
6696 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6697 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6698 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6702 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6703 @end deffn
6704 @end deffn
6705
6706 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6707 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6708 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6709 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6710 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6711
6712 @example
6713 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6714 @end example
6715
6716 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6717 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6718 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6719 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6720 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6721 disabled.
6722
6723 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6724 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6725 @quotation Warning
6726 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6727 applied to all of them.
6728 @end quotation
6729 @end deffn
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6733 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6734 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6735 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6736 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6737
6738 @example
6739 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6740 @end example
6741
6742 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6743 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6744 the flash driver.
6745
6746 @example
6747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6748 @end example
6749
6750 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6751 as per the following example.
6752 @example
6753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6754 @end example
6755
6756 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6757
6758 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6759 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6760 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6761 @end deffn
6762
6763 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6764 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6765 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6766 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6767 @end deffn
6768
6769 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6770 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6771 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6775 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6776 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6777 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6778 @end deffn
6779
6780 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6781 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6782 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6783 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6787 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6788 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6789 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6790 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6791 @end deffn
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6795 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6796 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6797 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6798 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6799
6800 @example
6801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6802 @end example
6803
6804 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6805 as per the following example.
6806 @example
6807 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6808 @end example
6809
6810 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6811 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6812 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6816 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6817 the flash driver.
6818
6819 @example
6820 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6821 @end example
6822
6823 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6824
6825 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6826 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6827 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6828 @end deffn
6829
6830 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6831 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6832 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6836 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6837 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6841 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6842 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6846 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6847 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6848 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6849 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6850 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6854 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6855 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6856 @end deffn
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6860 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6861 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6862 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6863 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6864
6865 @example
6866 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6867 @end example
6868
6869 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6870 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6871 the flash driver.
6872
6873 @example
6874 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6875 @end example
6876
6877 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6878
6879 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6880 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6881 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6882 @end deffn
6883
6884 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6885 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6886 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6887 @end deffn
6888
6889 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6890 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6891 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6895 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6896 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6897 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6898 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6899
6900 Example usage:
6901 @example
6902 # read OPTSR_CUR
6903 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6904 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6905 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6906 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6907 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6908 @end example
6909 @end deffn
6910
6911 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6912 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6913 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6914 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6915 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6916 will be touched).
6917
6918 Example usage:
6919 @example
6920 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6921 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6922 @end example
6923 @end deffn
6924 @end deffn
6925
6926 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6927 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6928 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6929 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6930 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6931
6932 @example
6933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6934 @end example
6935
6936 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6937 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6938 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6939 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6940 second bank.
6941
6942 @example
6943 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6944 @end example
6945
6946 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6947
6948 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6949 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6950 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6951 @end deffn
6952
6953 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6954 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6955 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6956 @end deffn
6957
6958 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6959 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6960 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6961 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6962 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6963 @end deffn
6964 @end deffn
6965
6966 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6967 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6968 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6969 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6970 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
6971 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6972 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6973
6974 @example
6975 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6976 @end example
6977
6978 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6979 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6980 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
6981 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
6982
6983 @example
6984 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6985 @end example
6986
6987 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6988
6989 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6990 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6991 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6992 @end deffn
6993
6994 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6995 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6996 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7000 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7001 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7002 @end deffn
7003
7004 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7005 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7006 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7007 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7008
7009 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7010 @example
7011 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7012 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7013 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7014 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7015 @end example
7016
7017 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7018 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7022 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7023 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7024 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7025 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7026
7027 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7028 @example
7029 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7030 @end example
7031
7032 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7033 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7034 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7038 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7039 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7040 @end deffn
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7044 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7045 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7046 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7047 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7048
7049 @example
7050 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7051 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7052 @end example
7053
7054 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7055 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7056 for the specified flash bank.
7057 @end deffn
7058 @end deffn
7059
7060 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7061 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7062 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7063 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7064 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7065
7066 @example
7067 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7068 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7069 @end example
7070
7071 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7072 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7073 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7074
7075 @itemize @bullet
7076 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7077 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7078 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7079 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7080 @end itemize
7081 @end deffn
7082
7083 @end deffn
7084
7085 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7086 @cindex str9xpec
7087
7088 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7089 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7090 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7091 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7092
7093 Here is some background info to help
7094 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7095 the str9:
7096 @enumerate
7097 @item
7098 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7099 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7100 @item
7101 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7102 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7103 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7104 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7105 @end enumerate
7106
7107 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7108 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7109 configured for flash bank 0.
7110 @example
7111 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7112 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7113 adapter assert srst
7114 # turn off target polling
7115 poll off
7116 # disable str9 core
7117 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7118 # read option bytes
7119 str9xpec options_read 0
7120 # re-enable str9 core
7121 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7122 poll on
7123 reset halt
7124 @end example
7125 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7126 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7127 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7128 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7129
7130 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7131
7132 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7133 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7137 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7138 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7142 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7143 erase the device.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7147 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7148 @end deffn
7149
7150 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7151 Configure str9 boot bank.
7152 @end deffn
7153
7154 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7155 Configure str9 lvd source.
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7159 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7160 @end deffn
7161
7162 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7163 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7164 @end deffn
7165
7166 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7167 Read str9 option bytes.
7168 @end deffn
7169
7170 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7171 Write str9 option bytes.
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7175 unlock str9 device.
7176 @end deffn
7177
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7181 @cindex swm050
7182 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7183
7184 @example
7185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7186 @end example
7187
7188 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7189
7190 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7191 Erases the entire flash bank.
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196
7197 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7198 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7199 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7200 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7201
7202 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7203
7204 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7205 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7209 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7213 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7214 the flash clock.
7215 @end deffn
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7219 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7220 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7221 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7222 correct bank config.
7223
7224 @example
7225 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7226 @end example
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7230 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7231 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7235 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7236 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7237
7238 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7239
7240 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7241 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7245 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @end deffn
7249
7250 @section NAND Flash Commands
7251 @cindex NAND
7252
7253 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7254 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7255 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7256
7257 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7258 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7259 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7260 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7261 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7262 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7263
7264 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7265 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7266 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7267 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7268 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7269 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7270 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7271 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7272 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7273 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7274
7275 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7276 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7277 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7278 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7279 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7280 every 512 bytes of data.
7281
7282 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7283 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7284 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7285 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7286 ECC mode is used.
7287
7288 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7289 @enumerate
7290 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7291 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7292 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7293 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7294 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7295 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7296 to access that device.
7297 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7298 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7299 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7300 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7301 de-brick a board.
7302 @end enumerate
7303
7304 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7305 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7306 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7307 are only 32 bits wide.
7308 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7309 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7310 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7311 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7312
7313 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7314 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7315 @cindex NAND configuration
7316
7317 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7318 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7319 OpenOCD has initialized.
7320
7321 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7322 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7323 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7324 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7325 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7326 they were a single (larger) device.
7327 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7328 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7329
7330 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7331 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7332 configuration files, not interactively.
7333
7334 @itemize @bullet
7335 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7336 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7337 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7338 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7339 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7340 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7341 commands to the NAND controller.
7342 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7343 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7344 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7345 for more information.
7346 @end itemize
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 @deffn Command {nand list}
7350 Prints a summary of each device declared
7351 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7352 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7353 @example
7354 > nand list
7355 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7356 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7357 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7358 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7359 >
7360 @end example
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7364 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7365 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7366 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7367 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7368 it with most other NAND commands.
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7372
7373 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7374 @cindex NAND reading
7375 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7376 starting at the specified offset.
7377 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7378
7379 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7380 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7381
7382 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7383 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7384 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7385
7386 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7387 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7388 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7389 method which handled that error correction.
7390
7391 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7392 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7393 @itemize @bullet
7394 @item no oob_* parameter
7395 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7396 @item @code{oob_raw}
7397 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7398 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7399 spare areas associated with each data page.
7400 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7401 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7402 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7403 @item @code{oob_only}
7404 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7405 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7406 spare areas associated with each data page.
7407 @end itemize
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7411 @cindex NAND erasing
7412 @cindex NAND programming
7413 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7414 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7415 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7416 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7417 If those parameters are not specified,
7418 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7419 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7420
7421 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7422 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7423 block marker.
7424 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7425 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7426 @end deffn
7427
7428 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7429 @cindex NAND writing
7430 @cindex NAND programming
7431 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7432 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7433 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7434 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7435
7436 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7437 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7438
7439 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7440 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7441 past the end of the device.
7442 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7443 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7444 if that's being written.)
7445
7446 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7447 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7448 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7449
7450 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7451 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7452 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7453 @itemize @bullet
7454 @item no oob_* parameter
7455 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7456 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7457 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7458 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7459 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7460 @item @code{oob_only}
7461 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7462 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7463 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7464 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7465 @item @code{oob_raw}
7466 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7467 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7468 un-altered OOB.
7469 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7470 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7471 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7472 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7473 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7474 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7475 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7476 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7477 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7478 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7479 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7480 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7481 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7482 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7483 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7484 @end itemize
7485 @end deffn
7486
7487 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7488 @cindex NAND verification
7489 @cindex NAND programming
7490 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7491 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7492 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7493
7494 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7495 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7496
7497 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7498 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7499 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7500 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7501 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7502
7503 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7504 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7505 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7506
7507 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7508 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7509 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7510 be removed in a future release.
7511 @end deffn
7512
7513 @subsection Other NAND commands
7514 @cindex NAND other commands
7515
7516 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7517 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7518 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7519 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7520 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7521 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7522 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7523 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7524
7525 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7526 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7527 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7531 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7532 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7533 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7534 status for each block.
7535 @end deffn
7536
7537 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7538 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7539 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7540
7541 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7542 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7543 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7544 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7545 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7546
7547 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7548 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7549 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7550 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7551 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7552 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7553 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7554 @end deffn
7555
7556 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7557 @subsection NAND Driver List
7558 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7559 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7560 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7561
7562 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7563 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7564 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7565 address of the ECC controller.
7566 @example
7567 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7568 @end example
7569 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7570 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7571 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7572 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7573 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7574 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7575 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7576 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7577 @end deffn
7578 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7579 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7580 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7584 properly configured for input or output.
7585 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7586 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7587 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7588 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7589 @end deffn
7590 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7591 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7592 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7593 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7594 @end deffn
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7598 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7599 chips from Texas Instruments.
7600 It takes three extra parameters:
7601 address of the NAND chip;
7602 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7603 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7604 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7605 @example
7606 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7607 @end example
7608 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7609 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7610 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7611 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7612 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7616 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7617 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7618 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7619 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7620 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7621 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7622 @end deffn
7623
7624 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7625 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7626 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7627 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7628 @end deffn
7629 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7630
7631 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7632 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7633 should work for this chip as well.
7634 @end deffn
7635
7636 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7637 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7638 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7639 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7640 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7641 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7642 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7643 @example
7644 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7645 @end example
7646 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7647 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7648 without parameter query status.
7649 @end deffn
7650 @end deffn
7651
7652 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7653 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7654 parameter: the address of the controller.
7655 @example
7656 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7657 @end example
7658 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7659 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7660 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7661 change any behavior.
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7665 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7666 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7667 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7668 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7669 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7670 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7671 specialized commands.
7672 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7673 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7674 change any behavior.
7675 @end deffn
7676
7677 @node Flash Programming
7678 @chapter Flash Programming
7679
7680 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7681 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7682 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7683
7684 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7685 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7686
7687 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7688 @enumerate
7689 @item 'init' is executed.
7690 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7691 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7692 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7693 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7694 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7695 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7696 @end enumerate
7697
7698 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7699
7700 @example
7701 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7702 # are optional parameters
7703 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7704 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7705
7706 # binary files need the flash address passing
7707 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7708 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7709 @end example
7710
7711 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7712 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7713 @cindex PLD
7714 @cindex FPGA
7715
7716 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7717 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7718 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7719 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7720 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7721 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7722 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7723
7724 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7725
7726 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7727 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7728 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7729
7730 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7731 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7732
7733 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7734 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7735 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7736 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7737 behavior.
7738 @end deffn
7739
7740 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7741 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7742 @end deffn
7743
7744 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7745 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7746 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7747 @end deffn
7748
7749 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7750
7751 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7752 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7753 that particular type of PLD.
7754
7755 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7756 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7757 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7758
7759 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7760 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7761 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7762
7763 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7764 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7765 for FPGA @var{num}.
7766 @end deffn
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @node General Commands
7770 @chapter General Commands
7771 @cindex commands
7772
7773 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7774 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7775 commands are documented elsewhere.
7776
7777 Intent:
7778 @itemize @bullet
7779 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7780 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7781 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7782 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7783
7784 @item @b{From the human}
7785 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7786 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7787
7788 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7789 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7790 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7791
7792 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7793 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7794 port is 5555.
7795 @end itemize
7796
7797
7798 @section Server Commands
7799
7800 @deffn {Command} exit
7801 Exits the current telnet session.
7802 @end deffn
7803
7804 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7805 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7806 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7807 Not every command provides helptext.
7808
7809 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7810 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7811 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7812 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7816 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7817 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7818 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7819 Useful in connection with script files
7820 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7821 @end deffn
7822
7823 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7824 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7825 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7826 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7827
7828 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7829 @example
7830 # redefine shutdown
7831 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7832 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7833 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7834 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7835 original_shutdown
7836 @}
7837 @end example
7838 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7839 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7840 @end deffn
7841
7842 @anchor{debuglevel}
7843 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7844 @cindex message level
7845 Display debug level.
7846 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7847 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7848 Level 0 is error messages only;
7849 level 1 adds warnings;
7850 level 2 adds informational messages;
7851 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7852 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7853 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7854 the command line along with the location of that log
7855 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7856 @xref{Running}.
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7860 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7861 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7862 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7863 @example
7864 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7865 @end example
7866 @end deffn
7867
7868 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7869 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7870 the default log output channel is stderr.
7871 @end deffn
7872
7873 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7874 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7875 @end deffn
7876
7877 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7878 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7879 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7880 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7881 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7882 @end deffn
7883
7884 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7885 @section Target State handling
7886 @cindex reset
7887 @cindex halt
7888 @cindex target initialization
7889
7890 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7891 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7892 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7893 a current target which is used to perform the
7894 various operations. The current target may be changed
7895 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7896 target which should become current.
7897
7898 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7899 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7900 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7901 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7902 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7903
7904 @emph{With no arguments}:
7905 list all available registers for the current target,
7906 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7907 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7908 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7909 are flagged as such.
7910
7911 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7912 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7913 bypassing any internal cache.
7914
7915 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7916 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7917 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7918 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7919 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7920 relevant module will flush such values.
7921
7922 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7923 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7924
7925 @example
7926 > reg
7927 ===== ARM registers
7928 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7929 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7930 (2) r2 (/32)
7931 ...
7932 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7933 >
7934 @end example
7935 @end deffn
7936
7937 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7938 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7939 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7940 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7941 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7942 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7943 (and enter debug mode).
7944 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7945
7946 @quotation Warning
7947 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7948 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7949 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7950 power mode by gating the core clock;
7951 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7952
7953 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7954 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7955 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7956 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7957 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7958 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7959
7960 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7961 work with a JTAG debugger.
7962 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7963 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7964 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7965 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7966 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7967 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7968 @end quotation
7969
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @deffn Command resume [address]
7973 Resume the target at its current code position,
7974 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7975 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @deffn Command step [address]
7979 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7980 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @anchor{resetcommand}
7984 @deffn Command reset
7985 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7986 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7987 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7988 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7989 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7990 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7991
7992 The optional parameter specifies what should
7993 happen after the reset.
7994 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7995 The other options will not work on all systems.
7996 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7997
7998 @itemize @minus
7999 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8000 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8001 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8002 @end itemize
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8006 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8007 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8008 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8009 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8010 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8011 state.
8012 @end deffn
8013
8014 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8015 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8016 Set values of reset signals.
8017 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8018 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8019 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8020 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8021
8022 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8023 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8024 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8025 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8026 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8027 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8028 the signal will not be modified.
8029
8030 @quotation Note
8031 TRST is specially handled.
8032 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8033 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8034 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8035 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8036 instead of the TRST signal.
8037 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8038 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8039 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8040 with handlers for that event.
8041 @end quotation
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @section I/O Utilities
8045
8046 These commands are available when
8047 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8048 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8049 notably the ZY1000.
8050 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8051
8052 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8053
8054 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8055 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8056 the text file @file{filename}.
8057 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8058 The last string is followed by a newline.
8059 @end deffn
8060
8061 @deffn Command cat filename
8062 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8066 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8067 into @file{dest_filename}.
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn Command ip
8071 @emph{No description provided.}
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn Command ls
8075 @emph{No description provided.}
8076 @end deffn
8077
8078 @deffn Command mac
8079 @emph{No description provided.}
8080 @end deffn
8081
8082 @deffn Command meminfo
8083 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8084 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8085 @end deffn
8086
8087 @deffn Command peek
8088 @emph{No description provided.}
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command poke
8092 @emph{No description provided.}
8093 @end deffn
8094
8095 @deffn Command rm filename
8096 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8097 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @deffn Command trunc filename
8101 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8105 @section Memory access commands
8106 @cindex memory access
8107
8108 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8109 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8110 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8111 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8112
8113 @enumerate
8114 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8115 to change the current target.
8116 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8117 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8118 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8119 @end enumerate
8120
8121 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8122 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8123 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8124 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8125 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8126 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8127 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8128 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8129 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8130 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8131 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8132 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8133 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8134 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8135 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8136 @end deffn
8137
8138 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8139 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8140 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8141 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8142 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8143 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8144 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8145 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8146 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8147 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8148 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8149 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8150 @end deffn
8151
8152 @anchor{imageaccess}
8153 @section Image loading commands
8154 @cindex image loading
8155 @cindex image dumping
8156
8157 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8158 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8159 binary file named @var{filename}.
8160 @end deffn
8161
8162 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8163 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8164 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8165 @end deffn
8166
8167 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8168 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8169 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8170 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8171 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8172 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8173 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8174 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8175 separately.
8176 @end deffn
8177
8178 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8179 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8180 The file format may optionally be specified
8181 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8182 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8183 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8184 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8185 @example
8186 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8187 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8188 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8189 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8190 $address $length
8191 @}
8192 @end example
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8196 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8197 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8198 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8199 The file format may optionally be specified
8200 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8201 @end deffn
8202
8203 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8204 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8205 The file format may optionally be specified
8206 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8207 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8211 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8212 The file format may optionally be specified
8213 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8214 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8215 @end deffn
8216
8217
8218 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8219 @cindex breakpoint
8220 @cindex watchpoint
8221
8222 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8223 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8224 watchpoints.
8225 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8226
8227 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8228 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8229 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8230 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8231 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8232 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8233
8234 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8235 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8236 @end deffn
8237
8238 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8239 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8243 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8244 @end deffn
8245
8246 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8247 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8248 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8249 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8250 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8251 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8252 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8253 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8254 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8255 @end deffn
8256
8257 @section Misc Commands
8258
8259 @cindex profiling
8260 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8261 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8262 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8263 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8264 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8265 limit the address range.
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268 @deffn Command {version}
8269 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8273 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8274 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8275 @end deffn
8276
8277 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8278 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8279 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8280 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8281
8282 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8283 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8284 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8285 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8286
8287 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8288 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8289 @cindex tracing
8290 @cindex ETM
8291 @cindex ETB
8292
8293 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8294 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8295 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8296
8297 @itemize
8298 @item
8299 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8300 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8301 supports such an interface.
8302 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8303 and trace port support.)
8304 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8305 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8306 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8307 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8308 in the board-specific configuration file.
8309 @item
8310 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8311 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8312 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8313 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8314 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8315 @end itemize
8316
8317 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8318
8319 @quotation Issues
8320 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8321 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8322
8323 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8324 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8325 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8326 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8327 dummy trace port driver}.
8328
8329 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8330 as well as tracing only during specific states
8331 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8332
8333 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8334 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8335 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8336 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8337 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8338
8339 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8340 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8341 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8342 this original style of JTAG access.
8343 @end quotation
8344
8345 @subsection ETM Configuration
8346 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8347
8348 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8349 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8350 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8351
8352 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8353 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8354 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8355 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8356 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8357 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8358 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8359 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8360 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8361
8362 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8363 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8364 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8365
8366 @quotation Warning
8367 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8368 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8369 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8370 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8371 @end quotation
8372
8373 @quotation Note
8374 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8375 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8376 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8377 what CPU activities are traced.
8378 @end quotation
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @deffn Command {etm info}
8382 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8383 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8384 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8385 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8386 @end deffn
8387
8388 @deffn Command {etm status}
8389 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8390 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8391 Did trace data overflow?
8392 Was it triggered?
8393 @end deffn
8394
8395 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8396 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8397 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8398 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8399 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8400
8401 @itemize
8402 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8403 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8404 The value is one of
8405 @option{none} (save nothing),
8406 @option{data} (save data),
8407 @option{address} (save addresses),
8408 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8409 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8410 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8411 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8412 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8413 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8414 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8415 trace stream without an image of the code.
8416 @end itemize
8417 @end deffn
8418
8419 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8420 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8421 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8422 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8423 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8424
8425 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8426 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8427 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8428 @end deffn
8429
8430 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8431
8432 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8433 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8434 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8435
8436 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8437 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8438 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8439 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8440 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8441 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8442 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8443
8444 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8445
8446 @itemize
8447 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8448 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8449 for instruction access within that function's body.
8450 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8451 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8452 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8453 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8454 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8455 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8456 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8457 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8458 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8459 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8460 @item @emph{... more}
8461 @end itemize
8462
8463 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8464 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8465
8466 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8467 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8468 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8469 @end deffn
8470
8471 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8472 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8476 Opens an image file.
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8480 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8481 @end deffn
8482
8483 @deffn Command {etm start}
8484 Starts trace data collection.
8485 @end deffn
8486
8487 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8488 Stops trace data collection.
8489 @end deffn
8490
8491 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8492 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8493
8494 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8495
8496 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8497 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8498 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8499 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8500 any trace data collection.}
8501 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8502 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8503 @end deffn
8504 @end deffn
8505
8506 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8507 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8508 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8509 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8510 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8511 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8512 @end deffn
8513 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8514 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8515 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8516 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8517 trace trigger becomes active.
8518
8519 @itemize
8520 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8521 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8522 afterwards.
8523 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8524 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8525 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8526 what caused that event to happen.
8527 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8528 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8529 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8530 how the event caused trouble.
8531 @end itemize
8532 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8533 @end deffn
8534
8535 @end deffn
8536
8537 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8538 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8539 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8540 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8541 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8542
8543 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8544 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8545
8546 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8547 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8548 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8549 @end deffn
8550
8551 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8552 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8556 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8557 @end deffn
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8561 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8562 @cindex CTI
8563
8564 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8565 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8566 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8567 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8568 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8569 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8570
8571 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8572 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8573 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8574 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8575 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8576 including additional configuration.
8577 @end deffn
8578
8579 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8580 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8584 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8588 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8589 @end deffn
8590
8591 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8592 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8593 @end deffn
8594
8595 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8596 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8600 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8601 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8602 @end deffn
8603
8604 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8605 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8606 of the CTI.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @deffn Command {cti names}
8610 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8611 useful in TCL scripting.
8612 @end deffn
8613
8614 @section Generic ARM
8615 @cindex ARM
8616
8617 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8618 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8619 commands that may be available.
8620
8621 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8622 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8623 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8624 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8625 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8626 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8627 @end deffn
8628
8629 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8630 @cindex disassemble
8631 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8632 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8633 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8634 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8635 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8636 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8637 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8638
8639 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8640 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8641 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8642 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8643 with a handful of exceptions.
8644 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8645 @end deffn
8646
8647 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8648 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8649 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8650 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8651 and using the MCR instruction.
8652 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8653 an ARM register.)
8654 @end deffn
8655
8656 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8657 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8658 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8659 and the MRC instruction.
8660 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8661 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8662 an ARM register.)
8663 @end deffn
8664
8665 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8666 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8667 core mode if necessary.
8668 @end deffn
8669
8670 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8671 @cindex ARM semihosting
8672 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8673
8674 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8675 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8676 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8677 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8678 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8679 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8683 @cindex ARM semihosting
8684 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8685
8686 @example
8687 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8688 @end example
8689
8690 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8691 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8692 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8693 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8694 @end deffn
8695
8696 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8697 @cindex ARM semihosting
8698 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8699 status.
8700
8701 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8702 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8703 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8704 debugger.
8705 @end deffn
8706
8707 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8708 @cindex ARM semihosting
8709 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8710
8711 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8712 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8713 the value returned by the target.
8714
8715 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8716 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8717 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8718 encountering a break.
8719
8720 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8721 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8722 to the debugger.
8723 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8724 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8725 request or equivalent").
8726
8727 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8728 this option (default: disabled).
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8732 @cindex ARMv4
8733 @cindex ARMv5
8734
8735 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8736 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8737 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8738 variant.
8739
8740 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8741 @cindex ARM7
8742 @cindex ARM9
8743
8744 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8745 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8746 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8747 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8748
8749 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8750 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8751 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8752 instead of breakpoints.
8753 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8754
8755 This should be
8756 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8757 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8758 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8759 @end deffn
8760
8761 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8762 @cindex DCC
8763 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8764 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8765 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8766
8767 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8768 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8769 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8770 @end deffn
8771
8772 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8773 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8774 that don't check completion of the operation.
8775 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8776
8777 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8778 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8779 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8780 @end deffn
8781
8782 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8783 @cindex ARM720T
8784
8785 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8786 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8787 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8788 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8789
8790 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8791 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8792 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8793
8794 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8795 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8796 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8797 @end deffn
8798
8799 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8800 @cindex ARM9
8801
8802 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8803 integer processors.
8804 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8805
8806 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8807 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8808 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8809 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8810
8811 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8812 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8813 @cindex vector_catch
8814 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8815 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8816 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8817 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8818 to those hardware vectors.
8819
8820 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8821 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8822 vector catch hardware to intercept
8823 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8824 @option{none} of them,
8825 or a list with one or more of the following:
8826 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8827 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8828 @end deffn
8829
8830 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8831 @cindex ARM920T
8832
8833 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8834 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8835 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8836 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8837 and ARM9 commands.
8838
8839 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8840 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8841 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8845 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8846 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8847 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8848 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8849 (Not all registers can be written.)
8850 @end deffn
8851
8852 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8853 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8854 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8855
8856 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8857 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8858 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8859 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8860 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8861 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8862 @end deffn
8863
8864 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8865 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8866 @end deffn
8867
8868 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8869 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8870 @end deffn
8871
8872 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8873 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8874
8875 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8876 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8877 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8878 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8879 and ARM9 commands.
8880
8881 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8882 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8883
8884 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8885 Print information about the caches found.
8886 @end deffn
8887
8888 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8889 @cindex ARM966E
8890
8891 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8892 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8893 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8894 and ARM9 commands.
8895
8896 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8897 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8898 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8899 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8900 ARM966E-S TRM.
8901 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8902 as required for BIST support.
8903 @end deffn
8904
8905 @subsection XScale specific commands
8906 @cindex XScale
8907
8908 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8909
8910 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8911 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8912 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8913 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8914 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8915 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8916 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8917
8918 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8919 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8920 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8921 the mini-IC.
8922
8923 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8924 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8925 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8926 code layout in memory:
8927 @example
8928 _vectors:
8929 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8930 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8931 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8932 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8933 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8934 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8935 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8936 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8937 .org 0x100
8938 .long real_reset_vector
8939 .long real_ui_handler
8940 .long real_swi_handler
8941 .long real_pf_abort
8942 .long real_data_abort
8943 .long 0 /* unused */
8944 .long real_irq_handler
8945 .long real_fiq_handler
8946 @end example
8947
8948 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8949 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8950 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8951 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8952 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8953 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8954 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8955 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8956 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8957 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8958 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8959 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8960 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8961 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8962 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8963 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8964 software.
8965
8966 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8967 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8968 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8969 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8970
8971 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8972 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8973 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8974 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8975 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8976 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8977 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8978 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8979 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8980
8981 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8982 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8983
8984 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8985 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8986 @end deffn
8987
8988 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8989 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8993 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8994 @end deffn
8995
8996 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8997 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8998 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9002 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9006 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9010 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9014 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9018 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9022 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9023 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9024 and modifying how it is emptied.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9028 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9029 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9030 The image @var{type} may be one of
9031 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9032 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9033 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9037 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9038 @cindex vector_catch
9039 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9040 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9041
9042 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9043 @example
9044 0x01 Trap Reset
9045 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9046 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9047 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9048 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9049 0x20 reserved
9050 0x40 Trap IRQ
9051 0x80 Trap FIQ
9052 @end example
9053 @end deffn
9054
9055 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9056 @cindex vector_table
9057
9058 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9059 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9060 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9061 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9062 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9063
9064 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9065
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9069 @cindex ARMv6
9070
9071 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9072 @cindex ARM11
9073
9074 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9075 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9076 which is enabled by default.
9077 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9078 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9079 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9080 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9081 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9082 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9083 @end deffn
9084
9085 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9086 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9087 which is enabled by default.
9088 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9089 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9090 @end deffn
9091
9092 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9093 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9094 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9095 they are disabled by default.
9096 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9100 @cindex vector_catch
9101 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9102 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9103 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9104
9105 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9106 for certain hardware events.
9107 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9108 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9109 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9113 @cindex ARMv7
9114 @cindex ARMv8
9115
9116 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9117 @cindex Cortex-A
9118
9119 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9120 display information about target caches
9121 @end deffn
9122
9123 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9124 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9125 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9126 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9127 Defaults to 'off'.
9128 @end deffn
9129
9130 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9131 Initialize core debug
9132 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9133 @end deffn
9134
9135 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9136 Display/set the current SMP mode
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9140 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9144 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9145 @end deffn
9146
9147 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9148 configure l2x cache
9149 @end deffn
9150
9151 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9152 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9153 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9154 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9155 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9156 @end deffn
9157
9158 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9159 @cindex Cortex-R
9160
9161 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9162 Initialize core debug
9163 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9164 @end deffn
9165
9166 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9167 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9168 @end deffn
9169
9170
9171 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9172 @cindex tracing
9173 @cindex SWO
9174 @cindex SWV
9175 @cindex TPIU
9176 @cindex ITM
9177 @cindex ETM
9178
9179 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9180 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9181 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9182
9183 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9184 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9185 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9186 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9187
9188 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9189 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9190 debugger adapter features.
9191
9192 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9193 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9194
9195 Command options:
9196 @itemize @minus
9197 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9198 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9199 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9200 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9201 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9202 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9203 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9204 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9205 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9206 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9207 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9208 coding;
9209 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9210 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9211 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9212 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9213 data is to be output via SWO;
9214 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9215 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9216 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9217 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9218 rate automatically.
9219 @end itemize
9220
9221 Example usage:
9222 @enumerate
9223 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9224 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9225 enough to:
9226 @example
9227 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9228 ...
9229 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9230 ...
9231 @end example
9232 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9233 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9234 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9235 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9236 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9237 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9238 @example
9239 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9240 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9241 @end example
9242 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9243 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9244 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9245 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9246 @example
9247 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9248 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9249 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9250 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9251 @end example
9252 @end enumerate
9253 @end deffn
9254
9255 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9256 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9257 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9261 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9262 @end deffn
9263
9264 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9265 @cindex Cortex-M
9266
9267 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9268 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9269
9270 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9271 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9272 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9273 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9274 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9275 the step command leaves with the core running.
9276
9277 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9278 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9279 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9280 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9281
9282 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9283 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9284 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9285 does.
9286
9287 Default is @option{auto}.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9291 @cindex vector_catch
9292 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9293 for certain hardware events.
9294
9295 Parameters request interception of
9296 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9297 @option{none} of them,
9298 or one or more of the following:
9299 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9300 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9301 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9302 @option{irq_err},
9303 @option{state_err},
9304 @option{chk_err}, or
9305 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9306 @option{reset}.
9307 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9308 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9309 are mapped to HardFault.
9310 UsageFault checks for
9311 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9312 must also be explicitly enabled.
9313
9314 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9315 @end deffn
9316
9317 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9318 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9319 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9320
9321 @itemize @minus
9322 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9323 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9324 @end itemize
9325
9326 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9327 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9328 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9329 to manually reset the peripherals.
9330 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9331
9332 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9333 instead.
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9337 @cindex ARMv8-A
9338 @cindex aarch64
9339
9340 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9341 Display information about target caches
9342 @end deffn
9343
9344 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9345 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9346 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9347 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9348 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9349 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9350 @end deffn
9351
9352 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9353 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9354 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9355 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9356 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9357 @end deffn
9358
9359 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9360 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9361 @option{on}.
9362 @end deffn
9363
9364 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9365 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9366 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9367 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9368 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9369 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9370 @end deffn
9371
9372 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9373
9374 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9375 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9376
9377 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9378
9379 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9380 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9381 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9385 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9386 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9387 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9388 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9389 @end deffn
9390
9391 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9392
9393 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9394 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9395 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9399
9400 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9401 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9402 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9403 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9404 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9405 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9406 can be collected.
9407
9408 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9409 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9410 tooling.
9411
9412 @quotation Issues
9413 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9414 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9415 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9416 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9417
9418 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9419 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9420 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9421 software operation on the CPU.
9422 @end quotation
9423
9424 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9425 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9426 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9427 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9428 @end deffn
9429
9430 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9431 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9435 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9436 control is disabled.
9437 @end deffn
9438
9439 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9440 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9441 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9442 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9443
9444 Supported trace formats:
9445 @itemize
9446 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9447 timing to be determined.
9448 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9449 addresses.
9450 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9451 @end itemize
9452 @end deffn
9453
9454 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9455 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9456 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9457 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9458
9459 Supported conditions:
9460 @itemize
9461 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9462 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9463 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9464 instruction matches start data and mask.
9465 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9466 instruction matches start data and mask.
9467 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9468 data and mask.
9469 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9470 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9471 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9472 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9473 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9474 @end itemize
9475 @end deffn
9476
9477 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9478 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9479 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9480 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9481
9482 Supported conditions:
9483 @itemize
9484 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9485 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9486 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9487 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9488 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9489 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9490 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9491 data and mask.
9492 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9493 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9494 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9495 @end itemize
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9499 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9500
9501 Supported triggers:
9502 @itemize
9503 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9504 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9505 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9506 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9507 collection.
9508 @end itemize
9509 @end deffn
9510
9511 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9512
9513 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9514 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9515 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9516 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9517 @end deffn
9518
9519 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9520 Display trace configuration.
9521 @end deffn
9522
9523 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9524 Display trace collection status.
9525 @end deffn
9526
9527 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9528 Start manual trace collection.
9529 @end deffn
9530
9531 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9532 Stop manual trace collection.
9533 @end deffn
9534
9535 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9536 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9537 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9538 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9539 @option{size} options using DMA.
9540 @end deffn
9541
9542 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9543 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9544 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9545 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9546 @option{size} options using DMA.
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @section Intel Architecture
9550
9551 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9552 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9553 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9554 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9555 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9556 @itemize
9557 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9558 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9559 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9560 @end itemize
9561
9562 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9563 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9564 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9565
9566 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9567 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9568 @end deffn
9569
9570 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9571 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9572 @end deffn
9573
9574 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9575 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9576 @end deffn
9577
9578 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9579 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9580 @end deffn
9581
9582 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9583 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9584 @end deffn
9585
9586 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9587 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9588 @end deffn
9589
9590 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9591
9592 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9593 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9594
9595 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9596 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9597 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9598 @end deffn
9599 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9600 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9601
9602 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9603
9604 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9605 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9606 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9607 @end deffn
9608
9609 @subsection Registers commands
9610 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9611 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9612 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9613
9614 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9615
9616 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9617 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9618 and "timer" groups.
9619
9620 @emph{example:}
9621 @example
9622 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9623 @end example
9624
9625
9626 @end deffn
9627 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9628 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9629
9630 @emph{group} can be "system",
9631 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9632 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @section RISC-V Architecture
9636
9637 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9638 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9639 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9640 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9641 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9642 implement version 0.11.
9643
9644 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9645
9646 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9647 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9648 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9649
9650 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9651
9652 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9653 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9654 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9655
9656 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9657 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9658 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9659 CSRs.
9660 @end deffn
9661
9662 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9663 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9664 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9665 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9666 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9667 This command must be executed before `init`.
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9671 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9672 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9673 @end deffn
9674
9675 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9676 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9677 deasserted.
9678 @end deffn
9679
9680 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9681 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9682 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9683 @end deffn
9684
9685 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9686 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9687 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9688 @end deffn
9689
9690 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9691 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9692 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9693 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9694 values.
9695
9696 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9697 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9698 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9699 @end deffn
9700
9701 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9702
9703 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9704 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9705 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9706 @example
9707 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9708 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9709 @end example
9710
9711 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9712 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9713 @end deffn
9714
9715 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9716 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9717 @end deffn
9718
9719 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9720
9721 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9722 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9723
9724 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9725 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9726 @end deffn
9727
9728 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9729 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9730 @end deffn
9731
9732 @section ARC Architecture
9733 @cindex ARC
9734
9735 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9736 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9737 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9738 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9739 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9740 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9741 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9742 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9743 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9744 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9745 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9746 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9747 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9748 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9749 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9750
9751
9752 @subsection General ARC commands
9753
9754 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9755
9756 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9757 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9758 arguments:
9759
9760 @itemize @bullet
9761
9762 @item @code{-name} name
9763 @*Name of a register.
9764
9765 @item @code{-num} number
9766 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9767
9768 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9769 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9770
9771 @end itemize
9772
9773 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9774
9775 @itemize @bullet
9776
9777 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
9778 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
9779 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
9780 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
9781 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
9782 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
9783
9784 @item @code{-core}
9785 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
9786 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
9787 spaces.
9788
9789 @item @code{-bcr}
9790 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
9791 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
9792 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
9793 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
9794 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
9795
9796 @item @code{-type} type_name
9797 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
9798 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
9799
9800 @item @code{-g}
9801 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
9802 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
9803 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
9804 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
9805 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
9806
9807 @end itemize
9808
9809 @end deffn
9810
9811 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
9812 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
9813 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
9814 @end deffn
9815
9816 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
9817 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
9818 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
9819 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
9820 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
9821 startbit endbit}.
9822 @end deffn
9823
9824 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
9825 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
9826 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
9827 @end deffn
9828
9829 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
9830 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
9831 as an argument for a single command invocation.
9832 @end deffn
9833
9834 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
9835
9836 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
9837 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
9838 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9839 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9840
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
9844 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
9845 registers.
9846 @end deffn
9847
9848 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
9849 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
9850 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9851 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9852
9853 @end deffn
9854
9855 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
9856 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
9857 registers.
9858 @end deffn
9859
9860 @section STM8 Architecture
9861 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
9862 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
9863
9864 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
9865 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
9866
9867 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9868 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9869 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9870 @cindex tracing
9871 @cindex libdcc
9872 @cindex DCC
9873 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9874 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9875 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9876 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9877
9878 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9879 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9880 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9881 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9882 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9883 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9884
9885 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9886 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9887 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9888 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9889 The target being debugged may
9890 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9891 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9892 each supported by a command:
9893
9894 @itemize
9895 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9896 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9897 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9898 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9899
9900 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9901 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9902 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9903
9904 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9905 and then displayed at any time.
9906 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9907
9908 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9909 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9910 @end itemize
9911
9912 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9913 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9914 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9915 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9916 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9917 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9918 does the same thing.
9919
9920 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9921 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9922 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9923 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9924 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9925
9926 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9927 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9928 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9929 @end deffn
9930
9931 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9932 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9933 in the order they triggered.
9934 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9935 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9936 history records.
9937 @end deffn
9938
9939 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9940 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9941 they have been triggered.
9942 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9943 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9944 and associates it with that identifier.
9945
9946 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9947 are not related except by this command.
9948 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9949 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9950 @end deffn
9951
9952
9953 @node JTAG Commands
9954 @chapter JTAG Commands
9955 @cindex JTAG Commands
9956 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9957 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9958 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9959 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9960 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9961
9962 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9963 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9964
9965 @itemize @bullet
9966 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9967 devices such as a CPUs.
9968 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9969 standard state machine (in parallel)
9970 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9971 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9972 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9973 while the reading previous ones.
9974 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9975 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9976 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9977 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9978 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9979 registers.
9980 @end itemize
9981
9982 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9983
9984 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9985 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9986 the order of TAP state transitions.
9987 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9988 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9989 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9990 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9991 these commands are not available.
9992
9993 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9994 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9995 that specify the entire register.
9996 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9997 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9998 The return value holds the original value of each
9999 of those fields.
10000
10001 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10002 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10003 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10004 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10005 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10006
10007 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10008 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10009
10010 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10011 in that state.
10012 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10013 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10014 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10015
10016 @quotation Warning
10017 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10018 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10019 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10020 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10021 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10022 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10023 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10024 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10025 @end quotation
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10029 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10030 This may be used for performance tuning.
10031
10032 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10033 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10034 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10035 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10036 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10037 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10038 @end deffn
10039
10040 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10041 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10042 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10043 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10044 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10045 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10046
10047 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10048 in that state.
10049 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10050 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10051 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10052
10053 @quotation Note
10054 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10055 register values, unlike data register values.
10056 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10057 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10058 @end quotation
10059 @end deffn
10060
10061 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10062 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10063 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10064 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10065 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10066 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10067 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10068 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10069 The final state must also be stable.
10070 @end deffn
10071
10072 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10073 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10074 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10075 Instructions often need some time
10076 to execute before they take effect.
10077 @end deffn
10078
10079 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10080 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10081
10082 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10083 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10084 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10085 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10086 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10087 @end deffn
10088
10089 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10090 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10091 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10092 must also be enabled.
10093 Default is enabled.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @section TAP state names
10097 @cindex TAP state names
10098
10099 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10100 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10101 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10102 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10103
10104 @itemize @bullet
10105 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10106 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10107 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10108 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10109 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10110 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10111 through the data register
10112 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10113 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10114 for update or more shifting
10115 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10116 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10117 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10118 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10119 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10120 through the instruction register
10121 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10122 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10123 for update or more shifting
10124 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10125 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10126 @end itemize
10127
10128 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10129 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10130 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10131 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10132
10133 @itemize @bullet
10134 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10135 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10136 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10137 may not be as expected.
10138 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10139 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10140 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10141 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10142 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10143 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10144 @end itemize
10145
10146 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10147 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10148
10149 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10150 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10151 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10152 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10153
10154 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10155 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10156 @cindex SVF
10157
10158 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10159 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10160 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10161 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10162
10163 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10164 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10165 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10166 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10167
10168 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10169 affect their semantics.
10170
10171 Command options:
10172 @itemize @minus
10173 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10174 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10175 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10176 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10177 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10178 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10179 on the real interface;
10180 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10181 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10182 errors.
10183 @end itemize
10184 @end deffn
10185
10186 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10187 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10188 @cindex XSVF
10189
10190 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10191 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10192 Xilinx devices.
10193 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10194 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10195
10196 @quotation Important
10197 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10198 @end quotation
10199
10200 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10201 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10202 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10203 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10204 that TAP.
10205 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10206 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10207 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10208 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10209 @end deffn
10210
10211 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10212 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10213 after building the software.
10214 You may find them useful:
10215
10216 @itemize
10217 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10218 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10219 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10220 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10221 @end itemize
10222
10223 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10224 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10225 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10226 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10227 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10228 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10229 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10230
10231
10232 @node Utility Commands
10233 @chapter Utility Commands
10234 @cindex Utility Commands
10235
10236 @section RAM testing
10237 @cindex RAM testing
10238
10239 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10240 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10241 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10242 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10243 hardware problems.
10244
10245 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10246 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10247 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10248 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10249
10250 Load the memory testing functions with
10251
10252 @example
10253 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10254 @end example
10255
10256 to get access to the following facilities:
10257
10258 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10259 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10260 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10261 @end deffn
10262
10263 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10264 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10265 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10266 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10267 @end deffn
10268
10269 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10270 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10271 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10272 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10273 @end deffn
10274
10275 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10276 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10277 @end deffn
10278
10279 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10280 @cindex Firmware recovery
10281
10282 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10283 devices recovery with JTAG.
10284
10285 For quickstart instructions run:
10286 @example
10287 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10288 @end example
10289
10290 @node TFTP
10291 @chapter TFTP
10292 @cindex TFTP
10293 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10294 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10295
10296 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10297 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10298 server (tftpd). For example,
10299
10300 @example
10301 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10302 @end example
10303
10304 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10305 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10306
10307 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10308 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10309 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10310 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10311
10312 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10313 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10314 @cindex GDB
10315 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10316 to debug remote targets.
10317 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10318
10319 @itemize
10320 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10321 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10322 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10323 as shown in this chapter.
10324 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10325 that also will probably need to be configured.
10326 @end itemize
10327
10328 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10329 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10330 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10331 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10332 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10333 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10334
10335 @section Connecting to GDB
10336 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10337 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10338 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10339 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10340 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10341
10342 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10343
10344 @enumerate
10345 @item
10346 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10347 @example
10348 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10349 @end example
10350 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10351
10352 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10353 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10354 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10355
10356 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10357 remote command above that becomes:
10358 @example
10359 tar ext :3333
10360 @end example
10361
10362 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10363 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10364 available through the command:
10365 @example
10366 target remote localhost:3333
10367 @end example
10368
10369 @item
10370 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10371 @example
10372 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10373 @end example
10374 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10375 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10376 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10377 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10378 @end enumerate
10379
10380 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10381 GDB command line.
10382
10383 @section Sample GDB session startup
10384
10385 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10386 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10387 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10388 small ARM program.
10389 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10390 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10391
10392 @example
10393 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10394 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10395 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10396 ...
10397 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10398 ...
10399 (gdb) load
10400 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10401 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10402 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10403 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10404 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10405 (gdb) continue
10406 Continuing.
10407 ...
10408 @end example
10409
10410 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10411 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10412 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10413 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10414
10415 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10416
10417 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10418 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10419 packet size and the device's memory map.
10420 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10421 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10422 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10423
10424 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10425 You may need to set those up by hand.
10426 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10427 something like:
10428
10429 @example
10430 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10431 @end example
10432
10433 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10434
10435 @example
10436 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10437 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10438 @end example
10439
10440 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10441 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10442 do not have such restrictions.
10443
10444 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10445 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10446 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10447 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10448
10449 @section Programming using GDB
10450 @cindex Programming using GDB
10451 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10452
10453 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10454 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10455 @example
10456 gdb_memory_map disable
10457 @end example
10458 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10459 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10460 working area.
10461
10462 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10463 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10464 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10465 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10466
10467 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10468 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10469
10470 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10471 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10472 @example
10473 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10474 @end example
10475
10476 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10477 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10478
10479 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10480 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10481 will be used.
10482
10483 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10484 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10485 @example
10486 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10487 @end example
10488 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10489
10490 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10491 can be used.
10492
10493 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10494 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10495 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10496
10497 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10498 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10499 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10500
10501 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10502 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10503 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10504 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10505 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10506 without any intrusion of the target process.
10507
10508 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10509 Place following command after target configuration:
10510 @example
10511 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10512 @end example
10513
10514 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10515 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10516 @example
10517 gdb_memory_map disable
10518 @end example
10519
10520 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10521 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10522 @example
10523 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10524 @end example
10525
10526 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10527 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10528
10529 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10530 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10531 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10532 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10533
10534 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10535 previously shown varibles.
10536
10537 @section RTOS Support
10538 @cindex RTOS Support
10539 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10540
10541 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10542 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10543
10544 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10545 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10546 GDB commands.
10547
10548 @* An example setup is below:
10549
10550 @example
10551 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10552 @end example
10553
10554 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10555
10556 Currently supported rtos's include:
10557 @itemize @bullet
10558 @item @option{eCos}
10559 @item @option{ThreadX}
10560 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10561 @item @option{linux}
10562 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10563 @item @option{embKernel}
10564 @item @option{mqx}
10565 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10566 @item @option{nuttx}
10567 @item @option{RIOT}
10568 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10569 @end itemize
10570
10571 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10572 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10573
10574 @table @code
10575 @item eCos symbols
10576 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10577 @item ThreadX symbols
10578 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10579 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10580 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10581 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10582 @tex
10583 \begingroup
10584 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10585 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10586 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10587 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10588 \par
10589 \endgroup
10590 @end tex
10591 @item linux symbols
10592 init_task.
10593 @item ChibiOS symbols
10594 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10595 @item embKernel symbols
10596 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10597 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10598 @item mqx symbols
10599 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10600 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10601 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10602 @item nuttx symbols
10603 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10604 @item RIOT symbols
10605 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10606 @end table
10607
10608 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10609 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10610
10611 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10612 along with the project:
10613
10614 @table @code
10615 @item FreeRTOS
10616 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10617 @item uC/OS-III
10618 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10619 @end table
10620
10621 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10622 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10623 @cindex SMP
10624 @cindex RTOS
10625 @cindex hwthread
10626 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10627 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10628 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10629 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10630 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10631 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10632 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10633 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10634 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10635
10636 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10637 @quotation Note
10638 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10639 @end quotation
10640
10641 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10642 @itemize @bullet
10643 @item j - smp status request
10644 @item J - smp set request
10645 @end itemize
10646
10647 OpenOCD implements :
10648 @itemize @bullet
10649 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10650 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10651 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10652 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10653 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10654 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10655 @end itemize
10656
10657 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10658 @itemize @bullet
10659 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10660 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10661 @example
10662 set $_core 1
10663 #Jc01 packet is sent
10664 print $_core
10665 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10666 @end example
10667
10668 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10669 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10670
10671 @example
10672 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10673 define toggle0
10674 maint packet Jc0
10675 continue
10676 main packet Jc-1
10677 end
10678 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10679 define toggle1
10680 maint packet Jc1
10681 continue
10682 main packet Jc-1
10683 end
10684 @end example
10685 @end itemize
10686
10687 @node Tcl Scripting API
10688 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10689 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10690 @cindex Tcl scripts
10691 @section API rules
10692
10693 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10694 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10695 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10696
10697 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10698 pair list and lists.
10699
10700 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10701 list.
10702
10703 @example
10704 > set foo(me) Duane
10705 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10706 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10707 > set foo(duck) Donald
10708 @end example
10709
10710 If one does this:
10711
10712 @example
10713 > set foo
10714 @end example
10715
10716 The result is:
10717
10718 @example
10719 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10720 @end example
10721
10722 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10723
10724 @verbatim
10725 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10726 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10727 }
10728 @end verbatim
10729
10730 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10731 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10732
10733 @section Internal low-level Commands
10734
10735 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10736 invoke directly.
10737
10738 @itemize @bullet
10739 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10740
10741 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10742 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10743
10744 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10745 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10746
10747 Return information about the flash banks
10748
10749 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10750
10751 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10752 its execution. Example:
10753
10754 @example
10755 > capture "reset init"
10756 @end example
10757
10758 @end itemize
10759
10760 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10761 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10762 called "flash_banks".
10763
10764 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10765
10766 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10767 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10768 holds one of the following values:
10769
10770 @itemize @bullet
10771 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10772 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10773 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10774 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10775 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10776 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10777 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10778 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10779 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10780 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10781 @end itemize
10782
10783 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10784
10785 @quotation Note
10786 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10787 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10788 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10789 is jim, not real tcl).
10790 @end quotation
10791
10792 @section Tcl RPC server
10793 @cindex RPC
10794
10795 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10796 commands and receive the results.
10797
10798 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10799 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10800 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10801 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10802 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10803
10804 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10805 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10806 @command{capture} command.
10807
10808 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10809
10810 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10811 @cindex RPC Notifications
10812
10813 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10814 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10815
10816 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10817 in the following format.
10818
10819 @verbatim
10820 type target_event event [event-name]
10821 type target_state state [state-name]
10822 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10823 @end verbatim
10824
10825 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10826 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10827 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10828 Defaults to off.
10829
10830 @end deffn
10831
10832 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10833 @cindex RPC trace output
10834
10835 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10836 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10837
10838 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10839
10840 @verbatim
10841 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10842 @end verbatim
10843
10844 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10845 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10846 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10847 Defaults to off.
10848
10849 See an example application here:
10850 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10851
10852 @end deffn
10853
10854 @node FAQ
10855 @chapter FAQ
10856 @cindex faq
10857 @enumerate
10858 @anchor{faqrtck}
10859 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10860 @cindex RTCK
10861 @cindex adaptive clocking
10862 @*
10863
10864 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10865 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10866 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10867 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10868
10869 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10870 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10871 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10872 @enumerate
10873 @item
10874 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10875 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10876 @item
10877 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10878 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10879 @end enumerate
10880
10881 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10882 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10883 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10884 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10885 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10886 power).
10887
10888 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10889 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10890 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10891 ARM926 scenario).
10892 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10893 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10894 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10895
10896 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10897 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10898 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10899 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10900
10901 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10902
10903 In order to make use of this,
10904 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10905 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10906
10907 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10908 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10909 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10910 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10911 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10912
10913 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10914 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10915 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10916 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10917
10918 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10919 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10920 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10921 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10922 with a CPLD.
10923 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10924 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10925 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10926 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10927 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10928 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10929
10930 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10931
10932 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10933
10934 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10935 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10936 depending on the chips on your board.
10937 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10938 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10939 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10940
10941 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10942 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10943 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10944
10945 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10946 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10947 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10948 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10949
10950 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10951 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10952 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10953 this way.
10954
10955 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10956 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10957 clock rate.
10958 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10959 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10960 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10961
10962 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10963
10964 @example
10965 # Example: 1.234MHz
10966 adapter speed 1234
10967 @end example
10968
10969
10970 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10971
10972 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10973 around Windows filenames.
10974
10975 @example
10976 > echo \a
10977
10978 > echo @{\a@}
10979 \a
10980 > echo "\a"
10981
10982 >
10983 @end example
10984
10985
10986 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10987
10988 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10989 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10990 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10991
10992 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10993 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10994 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10995
10996 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10997 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10998 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10999
11000 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11001
11002 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11003 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11004 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11005 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11006
11007 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11008 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11009 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11010
11011 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11012 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11013
11014 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11015 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11016 memory read caused data abort".
11017
11018 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11019 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11020 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11021 be done, feel free to add this here.
11022
11023 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11024 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11025 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11026 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11027 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11028 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11029 gracefully stops.
11030
11031 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11032 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11033 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11034
11035 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11036 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11037 bytes. Painful...
11038
11039
11040 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11041 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11042
11043 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11044 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11045 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11046 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11047 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11048 reset, everything else should work fine.
11049
11050 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11051 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11052 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11053 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11054
11055 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11056 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11057 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11058 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11059
11060 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11061
11062 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11063 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11064 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11065
11066 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11067 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11068
11069 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11070 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11071 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11072 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11073 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11074 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11075 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11076 clock frequency?
11077
11078 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11079 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11080 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11081 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11082 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11083
11084 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11085
11086 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11087 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11088 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11089 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11090 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11091 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11092 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11093
11094 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11095
11096 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11097 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11098 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11099 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11100
11101 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11102 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11103 particular order?
11104
11105 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11106 the same order used by the hardware.
11107
11108 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11109 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11110 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11111 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11112 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11113 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11114
11115 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11116 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11117 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11118 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11119
11120 @itemize @bullet
11121 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11122 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11123 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11124 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11125 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11126 @end itemize
11127
11128 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11129
11130 @itemize @bullet
11131 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11132 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11133 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11134 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11135 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11136 @end itemize
11137
11138
11139 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11140 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11141 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11142
11143 TODO.
11144
11145 @end enumerate
11146
11147 @node Tcl Crash Course
11148 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11149 @cindex Tcl
11150
11151 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11152 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11153 how the Tcl scripts work.
11154
11155 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11156 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11157 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11158 OpenOCD.
11159
11160 @section Tcl Rule #1
11161 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11162 @enumerate
11163 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11164 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11165 @end enumerate
11166
11167 The Tcl equal is this:
11168
11169 @enumerate
11170 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11171 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11172 @end enumerate
11173
11174 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11175 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11176
11177 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11178 There is a second pair of rules.
11179 @enumerate
11180 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11181 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11182 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11183 in Tcl.
11184 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11185 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11186 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11187 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11188 @end enumerate
11189
11190 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11191 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11192 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11193 Everything is a string}
11194
11195 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11196 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11197 difference is subtle.
11198 @enumerate
11199 @item Parse Time
11200 @item Evaluation Time
11201 @end enumerate
11202
11203 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11204 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11205 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11206
11207 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11208 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11209 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11210 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11211
11212 @itemize @bullet
11213 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11214 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11215 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11216 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11217 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11218 @example
11219 # bash example
11220 X=`date`
11221 echo "The Date is: $X"
11222 # Tcl example
11223 set X [date]
11224 puts "The Date is: $X"
11225 @end example
11226 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11227 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11228 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11229 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11230 is a string}
11231 @example
11232 set x "Dinner"
11233 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11234 @end example
11235 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11236 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11237 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11238 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11239 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11240 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11241 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11242 @end itemize
11243
11244 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11245
11246 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11247
11248 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11249
11250 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11251 the normal way.
11252
11253 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11254 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11255 line is immediately executed.
11256
11257 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11258 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11259
11260 @subsection Command Execution
11261
11262 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11263 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11264 control flow operators.
11265
11266 Commands are executed like this:
11267
11268 @enumerate
11269 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11270 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11271 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11272 @end enumerate
11273
11274 It sort of works like this:
11275 @example
11276 for(;;)@{
11277 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11278
11279 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11280
11281 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11282 @}
11283 @end example
11284
11285 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11286 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11287 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11288 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11289 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11290 ``LookupCommand()''
11291
11292 @subsection The FOR command
11293
11294 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11295 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11296 command just like any other command.
11297
11298 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11299 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11300 are:
11301
11302 @enumerate 0
11303 @item The ascii text 'for'
11304 @item The start text
11305 @item The test expression
11306 @item The next text
11307 @item The body text
11308 @end enumerate
11309
11310 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11311 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11312 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11313 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11314
11315 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11316 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11317
11318 @example
11319 int
11320 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11321 int *argc,
11322 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11323 @end example
11324
11325 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11326 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11327 still operates in the same basic way.
11328
11329 @subsection FOR command implementation
11330
11331 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11332 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11333
11334 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11335
11336 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11337
11338 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11339 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11340 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11341
11342 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11343 expression and returns a value.
11344
11345 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11346 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11347 @example
11348 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11349
11350 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11351
11352 int
11353 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11354 int argc,
11355 char **argv )
11356 @{
11357 if( argc != 5 )@{
11358 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11359 return ERROR;
11360 @}
11361
11362 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11363
11364 // Execute the start statement.
11365 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11366
11367 // Top of loop test
11368 for(;;)@{
11369 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11370 if( i == 0 )
11371 break;
11372
11373 // Execute the body
11374 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11375
11376 // Execute the LOOP part
11377 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11378 @}
11379
11380 // Return no error
11381 SetResult( interp, "" );
11382 return SUCCESS;
11383 @}
11384 @end example
11385
11386 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11387 in the same basic way.
11388
11389 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11390
11391 @subsection source and find commands
11392 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11393 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11394 @*Remember the parsing rules
11395 @enumerate
11396 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11397 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11398 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11399 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11400 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11401 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11402 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11403 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11404 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11405 @end enumerate
11406 @subsection format command
11407 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11408 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11409 @b{sprintf()}.
11410 @b{Example}
11411 @example
11412 set x 6
11413 set y 7
11414 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11415 @end example
11416 @enumerate
11417 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11418 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11419 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11420 @* Refer to Rule #1
11421 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11422 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11423 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11424 @end enumerate
11425 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11426 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11427 @example
11428 #1 Good
11429 proc someproc @{@} @{
11430 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11431 @}
11432 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11433 #2 Good - no variables
11434 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11435 #3 Good Curly Braces
11436 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11437 puts "Time: [date]"
11438 @}
11439 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11440 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11441 @end example
11442 @enumerate
11443 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11444 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11445 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11446 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11447 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11448 command.
11449 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11450 @*There are 4 examples:
11451 @enumerate
11452 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11453 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11454 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11455 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11456 @end enumerate
11457
11458 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11459 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11460 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11461
11462 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11463 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11464 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11465 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11466 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11467 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11468 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11469 @end enumerate
11470 @subsection Global Variables
11471 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11472 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11473 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11474 @example
11475 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11476 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11477 global x #Global variable X
11478 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11479 @}
11480 @end example
11481 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11482 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11483 @example
11484 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11485 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11486 # Create var name
11487 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11488 # Make it a global
11489 global $vn
11490 # Set it.
11491 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11492 @}
11493 @end example
11494 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11495 @example
11496 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11497 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11498 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11499 @}
11500 @end example
11501
11502 @include fdl.texi
11503
11504 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11505 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11506 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11507 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11508 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11509 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11510
11511 @printindex cp
11512
11513 @node Command and Driver Index
11514 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11515 @printindex fn
11516
11517 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)